1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
2 /*
3 * mac80211 <-> driver interface
4 *
5 * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc.
6 * Copyright 2006-2007 Jiri Benc <jbenc@suse.cz>
7 * Copyright 2007-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
8 * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
9 * Copyright (C) 2015 - 2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH
10 * Copyright (C) 2018 - 2024 Intel Corporation
11 */
12
13 #ifndef MAC80211_H
14 #define MAC80211_H
15
16 #include <linux/bug.h>
17 #include <linux/kernel.h>
18 #include <linux/if_ether.h>
19 #include <linux/skbuff.h>
20 #include <linux/ieee80211.h>
21 #include <linux/lockdep.h>
22 #include <net/cfg80211.h>
23 #include <net/codel.h>
24 #include <net/ieee80211_radiotap.h>
25 #include <linux/unaligned.h>
26
27 /**
28 * DOC: Introduction
29 *
30 * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements
31 * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document
32 * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware
33 * drivers.
34 */
35
36 /**
37 * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts
38 *
39 * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be
40 * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any
41 * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such
42 * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the
43 * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even
44 * tasklet function.
45 *
46 * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also
47 * use the non-IRQ-safe functions!
48 */
49
50 /**
51 * DOC: Warning
52 *
53 * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will
54 * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet.
55 */
56
57 /**
58 * DOC: Frame format
59 *
60 * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver,
61 * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are
62 * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the
63 * hardware.
64 *
65 * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features:
66 *
67 * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload
68 * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware.
69 *
70 * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to
71 * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU.
72 */
73
74 /**
75 * DOC: mac80211 workqueue
76 *
77 * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use.
78 * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by
79 * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the
80 * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback.
81 *
82 * mac80211 will flush the workqueue upon interface removal and during
83 * suspend.
84 *
85 * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock.
86 *
87 */
88
89 /**
90 * DOC: mac80211 software tx queueing
91 *
92 * mac80211 uses an intermediate queueing implementation, designed to allow the
93 * driver to keep hardware queues short and to provide some fairness between
94 * different stations/interfaces.
95 *
96 * Drivers must provide the .wake_tx_queue driver operation by either
97 * linking it to ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() or implementing a custom
98 * handler.
99 *
100 * Intermediate queues (struct ieee80211_txq) are kept per-sta per-tid, with
101 * another per-sta for non-data/non-mgmt and bufferable management frames, and
102 * a single per-vif queue for multicast data frames.
103 *
104 * The driver is expected to initialize its private per-queue data for stations
105 * and interfaces in the .add_interface and .sta_add ops.
106 *
107 * The driver can't access the internal TX queues (iTXQs) directly.
108 * Whenever mac80211 adds a new frame to a queue, it calls the .wake_tx_queue
109 * driver op.
110 * Drivers implementing a custom .wake_tx_queue op can get them by calling
111 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). Drivers using ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() will
112 * simply get the individual frames pushed via the .tx driver operation.
113 *
114 * Drivers can optionally delegate responsibility for scheduling queues to
115 * mac80211, to take advantage of airtime fairness accounting. In this case, to
116 * obtain the next queue to pull frames from, the driver calls
117 * ieee80211_next_txq(). The driver is then expected to return the txq using
118 * ieee80211_return_txq().
119 *
120 * For AP powersave TIM handling, the driver only needs to indicate if it has
121 * buffered packets in the driver specific data structures by calling
122 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(). For frames buffered in the ieee80211_txq
123 * struct, mac80211 sets the appropriate TIM PVB bits and calls
124 * .release_buffered_frames().
125 * In that callback the driver is therefore expected to release its own
126 * buffered frames and afterwards also frames from the ieee80211_txq (obtained
127 * via the usual ieee80211_tx_dequeue).
128 */
129
130 /**
131 * DOC: HW timestamping
132 *
133 * Timing Measurement and Fine Timing Measurement require accurate timestamps
134 * of the action frames TX/RX and their respective acks.
135 *
136 * To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine Timing
137 * Measurement frame RX, the low level driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp
138 * field to the frame RX timestamp and report the ack TX timestamp in the
139 * ieee80211_rx_status struct.
140 *
141 * Similarly, to report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine
142 * Timing Measurement frame TX, the driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp field
143 * to the frame TX timestamp and report the ack RX timestamp in the
144 * ieee80211_tx_status struct.
145 */
146 struct device;
147
148 /**
149 * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues
150 *
151 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues.
152 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP: bitmap with maximum queues set
153 */
154 enum ieee80211_max_queues {
155 IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES = 16,
156 IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP = BIT(IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES) - 1,
157 };
158
159 #define IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE 0xff
160
161 /**
162 * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211
163 * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice
164 * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video
165 * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort
166 * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background
167 */
168 enum ieee80211_ac_numbers {
169 IEEE80211_AC_VO = 0,
170 IEEE80211_AC_VI = 1,
171 IEEE80211_AC_BE = 2,
172 IEEE80211_AC_BK = 3,
173 };
174
175 /**
176 * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration
177 *
178 * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS
179 * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29.
180 *
181 * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255]
182 * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form
183 * 2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
184 * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min]
185 * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
186 * @acm: is mandatory admission control required for the access category
187 * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue
188 * @mu_edca: is the MU EDCA configured
189 * @mu_edca_param_rec: MU EDCA Parameter Record for HE
190 */
191 struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params {
192 u16 txop;
193 u16 cw_min;
194 u16 cw_max;
195 u8 aifs;
196 bool acm;
197 bool uapsd;
198 bool mu_edca;
199 struct ieee80211_he_mu_edca_param_ac_rec mu_edca_param_rec;
200 };
201
202 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats {
203 unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount;
204 unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount;
205 unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount;
206 unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount;
207 };
208
209 /**
210 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_change - change flag for channel context
211 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH: The channel width changed
212 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS: The number of RX chains changed
213 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR: radar detection flag changed
214 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL: switched to another operating channel,
215 * this is used only with channel switching with CSA
216 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH: The min required channel width changed
217 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_AP: The AP channel definition changed, so (wider
218 * bandwidth) OFDMA settings need to be changed
219 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_PUNCTURING: The punctured channel(s) bitmap
220 * was changed.
221 */
222 enum ieee80211_chanctx_change {
223 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH = BIT(0),
224 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS = BIT(1),
225 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR = BIT(2),
226 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL = BIT(3),
227 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH = BIT(4),
228 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_AP = BIT(5),
229 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_PUNCTURING = BIT(6),
230 };
231
232 /**
233 * struct ieee80211_chan_req - A channel "request"
234 * @oper: channel definition to use for operation
235 * @ap: the channel definition of the AP, if any
236 * (otherwise the chan member is %NULL)
237 */
238 struct ieee80211_chan_req {
239 struct cfg80211_chan_def oper;
240 struct cfg80211_chan_def ap;
241 };
242
243 /**
244 * struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf - channel context that vifs may be tuned to
245 *
246 * This is the driver-visible part. The ieee80211_chanctx
247 * that contains it is visible in mac80211 only.
248 *
249 * @def: the channel definition
250 * @min_def: the minimum channel definition currently required.
251 * @ap: the channel definition the AP actually is operating as,
252 * for use with (wider bandwidth) OFDMA
253 * @radio_idx: index of the wiphy radio used used for this channel
254 * @rx_chains_static: The number of RX chains that must always be
255 * active on the channel to receive MIMO transmissions
256 * @rx_chains_dynamic: The number of RX chains that must be enabled
257 * after RTS/CTS handshake to receive SMPS MIMO transmissions;
258 * this will always be >= @rx_chains_static.
259 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled on this channel.
260 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
261 * sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information.
262 */
263 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf {
264 struct cfg80211_chan_def def;
265 struct cfg80211_chan_def min_def;
266 struct cfg80211_chan_def ap;
267
268 int radio_idx;
269 u8 rx_chains_static, rx_chains_dynamic;
270
271 bool radar_enabled;
272
273 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
274 };
275
276 /**
277 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode - channel context switch mode
278 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF: Both old and new contexts already
279 * exist (and will continue to exist), but the virtual interface
280 * needs to be switched from one to the other.
281 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS: The old context exists but will stop
282 * to exist with this call, the new context doesn't exist but
283 * will be active after this call, the virtual interface switches
284 * from the old to the new (note that the driver may of course
285 * implement this as an on-the-fly chandef switch of the existing
286 * hardware context, but the mac80211 pointer for the old context
287 * will cease to exist and only the new one will later be used
288 * for changes/removal.)
289 */
290 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode {
291 CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF,
292 CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS,
293 };
294
295 /**
296 * struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch - vif chanctx switch information
297 *
298 * This is structure is used to pass information about a vif that
299 * needs to switch from one chanctx to another. The
300 * &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode defines how the switch should be
301 * done.
302 *
303 * @vif: the vif that should be switched from old_ctx to new_ctx
304 * @link_conf: the link conf that's switching
305 * @old_ctx: the old context to which the vif was assigned
306 * @new_ctx: the new context to which the vif must be assigned
307 */
308 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch {
309 struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
310 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf;
311 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *old_ctx;
312 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *new_ctx;
313 };
314
315 /**
316 * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags
317 *
318 * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed(), link_info_changed()
319 * and vif_cfg_changed() callbacks to indicate which parameter(s) changed.
320 *
321 * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated),
322 * also implies a change in the AID.
323 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed
324 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed
325 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed
326 * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed
327 * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed
328 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed
329 * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever
330 * reason (IBSS and managed mode)
331 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve
332 * new beacon (beaconing modes)
333 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be
334 * enabled/disabled (beaconing modes)
335 * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed
336 * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed
337 * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed.
338 * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note
339 * that it is only ever disabled for station mode.
340 * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface.
341 * @BSS_CHANGED_SSID: SSID changed for this BSS (AP and IBSS mode)
342 * @BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response changed for this BSS (AP mode)
343 * @BSS_CHANGED_PS: PS changed for this BSS (STA mode)
344 * @BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER: TX power setting changed for this interface
345 * @BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS: P2P powersave settings (CTWindow, opportunistic PS)
346 * changed
347 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO: Data from the AP's beacon became available:
348 * currently dtim_period only is under consideration.
349 * @BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH: The bandwidth used by this interface changed,
350 * note that this is only called when it changes after the channel
351 * context had been assigned.
352 * @BSS_CHANGED_OCB: OCB join status changed
353 * @BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS: VHT MU-MIMO group id or user position changed
354 * @BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE: keep alive options (idle period or protected
355 * keep alive) changed.
356 * @BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE: Multicast Rate setting changed for this interface
357 * @BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER: fine timing measurement request responder
358 * functionality changed for this BSS (AP mode).
359 * @BSS_CHANGED_TWT: TWT status changed
360 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD: OBSS Packet Detection status changed.
361 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR: BSS Color has changed
362 * @BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY: FILS discovery status changed.
363 * @BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
364 * status changed.
365 * @BSS_CHANGED_MLD_VALID_LINKS: MLD valid links status changed.
366 * @BSS_CHANGED_MLD_TTLM: negotiated TID to link mapping was changed
367 * @BSS_CHANGED_TPE: transmit power envelope changed
368 */
369 enum ieee80211_bss_change {
370 BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC = 1<<0,
371 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT = 1<<1,
372 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE = 1<<2,
373 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT = 1<<3,
374 BSS_CHANGED_HT = 1<<4,
375 BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES = 1<<5,
376 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT = 1<<6,
377 BSS_CHANGED_BSSID = 1<<7,
378 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON = 1<<8,
379 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED = 1<<9,
380 BSS_CHANGED_CQM = 1<<10,
381 BSS_CHANGED_IBSS = 1<<11,
382 BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER = 1<<12,
383 BSS_CHANGED_QOS = 1<<13,
384 BSS_CHANGED_IDLE = 1<<14,
385 BSS_CHANGED_SSID = 1<<15,
386 BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP = 1<<16,
387 BSS_CHANGED_PS = 1<<17,
388 BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER = 1<<18,
389 BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS = 1<<19,
390 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO = 1<<20,
391 BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH = 1<<21,
392 BSS_CHANGED_OCB = 1<<22,
393 BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS = 1<<23,
394 BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE = 1<<24,
395 BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE = 1<<25,
396 BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER = 1<<26,
397 BSS_CHANGED_TWT = 1<<27,
398 BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD = 1<<28,
399 BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR = 1<<29,
400 BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY = 1<<30,
401 BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP = BIT_ULL(31),
402 BSS_CHANGED_MLD_VALID_LINKS = BIT_ULL(33),
403 BSS_CHANGED_MLD_TTLM = BIT_ULL(34),
404 BSS_CHANGED_TPE = BIT_ULL(35),
405
406 /* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */
407 };
408
409 /*
410 * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number
411 * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP
412 * filtering will be disabled.
413 */
414 #define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4
415
416 /**
417 * enum ieee80211_event_type - event to be notified to the low level driver
418 * @RSSI_EVENT: AP's rssi crossed the a threshold set by the driver.
419 * @MLME_EVENT: event related to MLME
420 * @BAR_RX_EVENT: a BAR was received
421 * @BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT: Frames were released from the reordering buffer because
422 * they timed out. This won't be called for each frame released, but only
423 * once each time the timeout triggers.
424 */
425 enum ieee80211_event_type {
426 RSSI_EVENT,
427 MLME_EVENT,
428 BAR_RX_EVENT,
429 BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT,
430 };
431
432 /**
433 * enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data - relevant when event type is %RSSI_EVENT
434 * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi went below the threshold set by the driver.
435 * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi went above the threshold set by the driver.
436 */
437 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data {
438 RSSI_EVENT_HIGH,
439 RSSI_EVENT_LOW,
440 };
441
442 /**
443 * struct ieee80211_rssi_event - data attached to an %RSSI_EVENT
444 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data
445 */
446 struct ieee80211_rssi_event {
447 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data data;
448 };
449
450 /**
451 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
452 * @AUTH_EVENT: the MLME operation is authentication
453 * @ASSOC_EVENT: the MLME operation is association
454 * @DEAUTH_RX_EVENT: deauth received..
455 * @DEAUTH_TX_EVENT: deauth sent.
456 */
457 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data {
458 AUTH_EVENT,
459 ASSOC_EVENT,
460 DEAUTH_RX_EVENT,
461 DEAUTH_TX_EVENT,
462 };
463
464 /**
465 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
466 * @MLME_SUCCESS: the MLME operation completed successfully.
467 * @MLME_DENIED: the MLME operation was denied by the peer.
468 * @MLME_TIMEOUT: the MLME operation timed out.
469 */
470 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status {
471 MLME_SUCCESS,
472 MLME_DENIED,
473 MLME_TIMEOUT,
474 };
475
476 /**
477 * struct ieee80211_mlme_event - data attached to an %MLME_EVENT
478 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data
479 * @status: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status
480 * @reason: the reason code if applicable
481 */
482 struct ieee80211_mlme_event {
483 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data data;
484 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status status;
485 u16 reason;
486 };
487
488 /**
489 * struct ieee80211_ba_event - data attached for BlockAck related events
490 * @sta: pointer to the &ieee80211_sta to which this event relates
491 * @tid: the tid
492 * @ssn: the starting sequence number (for %BAR_RX_EVENT)
493 */
494 struct ieee80211_ba_event {
495 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
496 u16 tid;
497 u16 ssn;
498 };
499
500 /**
501 * struct ieee80211_event - event to be sent to the driver
502 * @type: The event itself. See &enum ieee80211_event_type.
503 * @u.rssi: relevant if &type is %RSSI_EVENT
504 * @u.mlme: relevant if &type is %AUTH_EVENT
505 * @u.ba: relevant if &type is %BAR_RX_EVENT or %BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT
506 * @u:union holding the fields above
507 */
508 struct ieee80211_event {
509 enum ieee80211_event_type type;
510 union {
511 struct ieee80211_rssi_event rssi;
512 struct ieee80211_mlme_event mlme;
513 struct ieee80211_ba_event ba;
514 } u;
515 };
516
517 /**
518 * struct ieee80211_mu_group_data - STA's VHT MU-MIMO group data
519 *
520 * This structure describes the group id data of VHT MU-MIMO
521 *
522 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
523 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
524 */
525 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data {
526 u8 membership[WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN];
527 u8 position[WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN];
528 };
529
530 /**
531 * struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params - FTM responder parameters
532 *
533 * @lci: LCI subelement content
534 * @civicloc: CIVIC location subelement content
535 * @lci_len: LCI data length
536 * @civicloc_len: Civic data length
537 */
538 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params {
539 const u8 *lci;
540 const u8 *civicloc;
541 size_t lci_len;
542 size_t civicloc_len;
543 };
544
545 /**
546 * struct ieee80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
547 * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
548 *
549 * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
550 * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
551 */
552 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery {
553 u32 min_interval;
554 u32 max_interval;
555 };
556
557 #define IEEE80211_TPE_EIRP_ENTRIES_320MHZ 5
558 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_eirp {
559 bool valid;
560 s8 power[IEEE80211_TPE_EIRP_ENTRIES_320MHZ];
561 u8 count;
562 };
563
564 #define IEEE80211_TPE_PSD_ENTRIES_320MHZ 16
565 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_psd {
566 bool valid;
567 s8 power[IEEE80211_TPE_PSD_ENTRIES_320MHZ];
568 u8 count, n;
569 };
570
571 /**
572 * struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe - parsed transmit power envelope information
573 * @max_local: maximum local EIRP, one value for 20, 40, 80, 160, 320 MHz each
574 * (indexed by TX power category)
575 * @max_reg_client: maximum regulatory client EIRP, one value for 20, 40, 80,
576 * 160, 320 MHz each
577 * (indexed by TX power category)
578 * @psd_local: maximum local power spectral density, one value for each 20 MHz
579 * subchannel per bss_conf's chanreq.oper
580 * (indexed by TX power category)
581 * @psd_reg_client: maximum regulatory power spectral density, one value for
582 * each 20 MHz subchannel per bss_conf's chanreq.oper
583 * (indexed by TX power category)
584 */
585 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe {
586 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_eirp max_local[2], max_reg_client[2];
587 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_psd psd_local[2], psd_reg_client[2];
588 };
589
590 /**
591 * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters
592 *
593 * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association
594 * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS.
595 *
596 * @vif: reference to owning VIF
597 * @bss: the cfg80211 bss descriptor. Valid only for a station, and only
598 * when associated. Note: This contains information which is not
599 * necessarily authenticated. For example, information coming from probe
600 * responses.
601 * @addr: (link) address used locally
602 * @link_id: link ID, or 0 for non-MLO
603 * @htc_trig_based_pkt_ext: default PE in 4us units, if BSS supports HE
604 * @uora_exists: is the UORA element advertised by AP
605 * @uora_ocw_range: UORA element's OCW Range field
606 * @frame_time_rts_th: HE duration RTS threshold, in units of 32us
607 * @he_support: does this BSS support HE
608 * @twt_requester: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
609 * mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
610 * @twt_responder: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
611 * mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
612 * @twt_protected: does this BSS support protected TWT frames
613 * @twt_broadcast: does this BSS support broadcast TWT
614 * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection
615 * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble
616 * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP)
617 * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing,
618 * valid in station mode only if after the driver was notified
619 * with the %BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO flag, will be non-zero then.
620 * @sync_tsf: last beacon's/probe response's TSF timestamp (could be old
621 * as it may have been received during scanning long ago). If the
622 * HW flag %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY is set, then this can
623 * only come from a beacon, but might not become valid until after
624 * association when a beacon is received (which is notified with the
625 * %BSS_CHANGED_DTIM flag.). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
626 * @sync_device_ts: the device timestamp corresponding to the sync_tsf,
627 * the driver/device can use this to calculate synchronisation
628 * (see @sync_tsf). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
629 * @sync_dtim_count: Only valid when %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY
630 * is requested, see @sync_tsf/@sync_device_ts.
631 * IMPORTANT: These three sync_* parameters would possibly be out of sync
632 * by the time the driver will use them. The synchronized view is currently
633 * guaranteed only in certain callbacks.
634 * Note also that this is not used with MLD associations, mac80211 doesn't
635 * know how to track beacons for all of the links for this.
636 * @beacon_int: beacon interval
637 * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp
638 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an
639 * index into the rate table configured by the driver in
640 * the current band.
641 * @beacon_rate: associated AP's beacon TX rate
642 * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
643 * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS
644 * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not
645 * @chanreq: Channel request for this BSS -- the hardware might be
646 * configured a higher bandwidth than this BSS uses, for example.
647 * @mu_group: VHT MU-MIMO group membership data
648 * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode like in &struct ieee80211_ht_operation.
649 * This field is only valid when the channel is a wide HT/VHT channel.
650 * Note that with TDLS this can be the case (channel is HT, protection must
651 * be used from this field) even when the BSS association isn't using HT.
652 * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value
653 * implies disabled. As with the cfg80211 callback, a change here should
654 * cause an event to be sent indicating where the current value is in
655 * relation to the newly configured threshold.
656 * @cqm_rssi_low: Connection quality monitor RSSI lower threshold, a zero value
657 * implies disabled. This is an alternative mechanism to the single
658 * threshold event and can't be enabled simultaneously with it.
659 * @cqm_rssi_high: Connection quality monitor RSSI upper threshold.
660 * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis
661 * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS.
662 * @hidden_ssid: The SSID of the current vif is hidden. Only valid in AP-mode.
663 * @txpower: TX power in dBm. INT_MIN means not configured.
664 * @txpower_type: TX power adjustment used to control per packet Transmit
665 * Power Control (TPC) in lower driver for the current vif. In particular
666 * TPC is enabled if value passed in %txpower_type is
667 * NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED (allow using less than specified from
668 * userspace), whereas TPC is disabled if %txpower_type is set to
669 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED (use value configured from userspace)
670 * @p2p_noa_attr: P2P NoA attribute for P2P powersave
671 * @allow_p2p_go_ps: indication for AP or P2P GO interface, whether it's allowed
672 * to use P2P PS mechanism or not. AP/P2P GO is not allowed to use P2P PS
673 * if it has associated clients without P2P PS support.
674 * @max_idle_period: the time period during which the station can refrain from
675 * transmitting frames to its associated AP without being disassociated.
676 * In units of 1000 TUs. Zero value indicates that the AP did not include
677 * a (valid) BSS Max Idle Period Element.
678 * @protected_keep_alive: if set, indicates that the station should send an RSN
679 * protected frame to the AP to reset the idle timer at the AP for the
680 * station.
681 * @ftm_responder: whether to enable or disable fine timing measurement FTM
682 * responder functionality.
683 * @ftmr_params: configurable lci/civic parameter when enabling FTM responder.
684 * @nontransmitted: this BSS is a nontransmitted BSS profile
685 * @transmitter_bssid: the address of transmitter AP
686 * @bssid_index: index inside the multiple BSSID set
687 * @bssid_indicator: 2^bssid_indicator is the maximum number of APs in set
688 * @ema_ap: AP supports enhancements of discovery and advertisement of
689 * nontransmitted BSSIDs
690 * @profile_periodicity: the least number of beacon frames need to be received
691 * in order to discover all the nontransmitted BSSIDs in the set.
692 * @he_oper: HE operation information of the BSS (AP/Mesh) or of the AP we are
693 * connected to (STA)
694 * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection parameters.
695 * @he_bss_color: BSS coloring settings, if BSS supports HE
696 * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery configuration
697 * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
698 * interval.
699 * @beacon_tx_rate: The configured beacon transmit rate that needs to be passed
700 * to driver when rate control is offloaded to firmware.
701 * @power_type: power type of BSS for 6 GHz
702 * @tpe: transmit power envelope information
703 * @pwr_reduction: power constraint of BSS.
704 * @eht_support: does this BSS support EHT
705 * @csa_active: marks whether a channel switch is going on.
706 * @mu_mimo_owner: indicates interface owns MU-MIMO capability
707 * @chanctx_conf: The channel context this interface is assigned to, or %NULL
708 * when it is not assigned. This pointer is RCU-protected due to the TX
709 * path needing to access it; even though the netdev carrier will always
710 * be off when it is %NULL there can still be races and packets could be
711 * processed after it switches back to %NULL.
712 * @color_change_active: marks whether a color change is ongoing.
713 * @color_change_color: the bss color that will be used after the change.
714 * @ht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HT LDPC capability.
715 * @vht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has VHT LDPC capability.
716 * @he_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HE LDPC capability.
717 * @vht_su_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
718 * beamformer
719 * @vht_su_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
720 * beamformee
721 * @vht_mu_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
722 * beamformer
723 * @vht_mu_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
724 * beamformee
725 * @he_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
726 * beamformer
727 * @he_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
728 * beamformee
729 * @he_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE MU
730 * beamformer
731 * @he_full_ul_mumimo: does this BSS support the reception (AP) or transmission
732 * (non-AP STA) of an HE TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU
733 * bandwidth
734 * @eht_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
735 * beamformer
736 * @eht_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
737 * beamformee
738 * @eht_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT MU
739 * beamformer
740 * @eht_80mhz_full_bw_ul_mumimo: in AP-mode, does this BSS support the
741 * reception of an EHT TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU
742 * bandwidth
743 */
744 struct ieee80211_bss_conf {
745 struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
746 struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
747
748 const u8 *bssid;
749 unsigned int link_id;
750 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
751 u8 htc_trig_based_pkt_ext;
752 bool uora_exists;
753 u8 uora_ocw_range;
754 u16 frame_time_rts_th;
755 bool he_support;
756 bool twt_requester;
757 bool twt_responder;
758 bool twt_protected;
759 bool twt_broadcast;
760 /* erp related data */
761 bool use_cts_prot;
762 bool use_short_preamble;
763 bool use_short_slot;
764 bool enable_beacon;
765 u8 dtim_period;
766 u16 beacon_int;
767 u16 assoc_capability;
768 u64 sync_tsf;
769 u32 sync_device_ts;
770 u8 sync_dtim_count;
771 u32 basic_rates;
772 struct ieee80211_rate *beacon_rate;
773 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
774 u16 ht_operation_mode;
775 s32 cqm_rssi_thold;
776 u32 cqm_rssi_hyst;
777 s32 cqm_rssi_low;
778 s32 cqm_rssi_high;
779 struct ieee80211_chan_req chanreq;
780 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data mu_group;
781 bool qos;
782 bool hidden_ssid;
783 int txpower;
784 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting txpower_type;
785 struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr p2p_noa_attr;
786 bool allow_p2p_go_ps;
787 u16 max_idle_period;
788 bool protected_keep_alive;
789 bool ftm_responder;
790 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params *ftmr_params;
791 /* Multiple BSSID data */
792 bool nontransmitted;
793 u8 transmitter_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
794 u8 bssid_index;
795 u8 bssid_indicator;
796 bool ema_ap;
797 u8 profile_periodicity;
798 struct {
799 u32 params;
800 u16 nss_set;
801 } he_oper;
802 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
803 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
804 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
805 u32 unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval;
806 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_tx_rate;
807 enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power power_type;
808
809 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe tpe;
810
811 u8 pwr_reduction;
812 bool eht_support;
813
814 bool csa_active;
815
816 bool mu_mimo_owner;
817 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf __rcu *chanctx_conf;
818
819 bool color_change_active;
820 u8 color_change_color;
821
822 bool ht_ldpc;
823 bool vht_ldpc;
824 bool he_ldpc;
825 bool vht_su_beamformer;
826 bool vht_su_beamformee;
827 bool vht_mu_beamformer;
828 bool vht_mu_beamformee;
829 bool he_su_beamformer;
830 bool he_su_beamformee;
831 bool he_mu_beamformer;
832 bool he_full_ul_mumimo;
833 bool eht_su_beamformer;
834 bool eht_su_beamformee;
835 bool eht_mu_beamformer;
836 bool eht_80mhz_full_bw_ul_mumimo;
837 };
838
839 /**
840 * enum mac80211_tx_info_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status
841 *
842 * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info.
843 *
844 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame.
845 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence
846 * number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment
847 * number and increasing the sequence number only when the
848 * IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly
849 * assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly
850 * for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from
851 * that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing.
852 * If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to
853 * assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE
854 * 802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for
855 * beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field.
856 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack
857 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination
858 * station
859 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame
860 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon
861 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU
862 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211.
863 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted
864 * because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to
865 * avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or
866 * firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station
867 * went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on
868 * the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for
869 * that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above),
870 * since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the
871 * hardware queue.
872 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged
873 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status
874 * is for the whole aggregation.
875 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned,
876 * so consider using block ack request (BAR).
877 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be
878 * set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will
879 * be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment)
880 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK: Internal to mac80211. Used to indicate
881 * that a frame can be transmitted while the queues are stopped for
882 * off-channel operation.
883 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP: This frame uses hardware encapsulation
884 * (header conversion)
885 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211,
886 * used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS
887 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211,
888 * used to indicate frame should not be encrypted
889 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER: This frame is a response to a poll
890 * frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD) or a non-bufferable MMPDU and must
891 * be sent although the station is in powersave mode.
892 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the
893 * transmit function after the current frame, this can be used
894 * by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the
895 * queue gets full.
896 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted
897 * after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not
898 * be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.)
899 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX: This frame was transmitted by the MLME
900 * code for connection establishment, this indicates that its status
901 * should kick the MLME state machine.
902 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211
903 * MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX
904 * status to user space)
905 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame
906 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this
907 * frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use.
908 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on
909 * the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done
910 * in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be
911 * handled properly by the device.
912 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP
913 * testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow
914 * TKIP countermeasures to be tested.
915 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE: This frame will be sent at non CCK rate.
916 * This flag is actually used for management frame especially for P2P
917 * frames not being sent at CCK rate in 2GHz band.
918 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP: This packet marks the end of service period,
919 * when its status is reported the service period ends. For frames in
920 * an SP that mac80211 transmits, it is already set; for driver frames
921 * the driver may set this flag. It is also used to do the same for
922 * PS-Poll responses.
923 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE: This frame will be sent at lowest rate.
924 * This flag is used to send nullfunc frame at minimum rate when
925 * the nullfunc is used for connection monitoring purpose.
926 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG: Don't fragment this packet even if it
927 * would be fragmented by size (this is optional, only used for
928 * monitor injection).
929 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED: A frame that was marked with
930 * IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK has been successfully transmitted without
931 * any errors (like issues specific to the driver/HW).
932 * This flag must not be set for frames that don't request no-ack
933 * behaviour with IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK.
934 *
935 * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't
936 * forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary.
937 */
938 enum mac80211_tx_info_flags {
939 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS = BIT(0),
940 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ = BIT(1),
941 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK = BIT(2),
942 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT = BIT(3),
943 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT = BIT(4),
944 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM = BIT(5),
945 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU = BIT(6),
946 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED = BIT(7),
947 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED = BIT(8),
948 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK = BIT(9),
949 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU = BIT(10),
950 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK = BIT(11),
951 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE = BIT(12),
952 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK = BIT(13),
953 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP = BIT(14),
954 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED = BIT(15),
955 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT = BIT(16),
956 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER = BIT(17),
957 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES = BIT(18),
958 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION = BIT(19),
959 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX = BIT(20),
960 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX = BIT(21),
961 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC = BIT(22),
962 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC = BIT(23) | BIT(24),
963 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN = BIT(25),
964 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE = BIT(26),
965 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE = BIT(27),
966 IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP = BIT(28),
967 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE = BIT(29),
968 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG = BIT(30),
969 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED = BIT(31),
970 };
971
972 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT 23
973
974 #define IEEE80211_TX_RC_S1G_MCS IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS
975
976 /**
977 * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmit control
978 *
979 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO: this frame is a port control
980 * protocol frame (e.g. EAP)
981 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE: This frame is a response to a poll
982 * frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD).
983 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT: This frame is injected with rate information
984 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU: This frame is an A-MSDU frame
985 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT: This frame is going through the fast_xmit path
986 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP: This frame skips mesh path lookup
987 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211,
988 * used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before
989 * it can be sent out.
990 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO: Do not overwrite the sequence number that
991 * has already been assigned to this frame.
992 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER: This frame should not be reordered
993 * relative to other frames that have this flag set, independent
994 * of their QoS TID or other priority field values.
995 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX: first MLO TX, used mostly internally
996 * for sequence number assignment
997 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_USE_RATE_MASK: Don't use rate mask for this frame
998 * which is transmitted due to scanning or offchannel TX, not in normal
999 * operation on the interface.
1000 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK: If not @IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, this
1001 * frame should be transmitted on the specific link. This really is
1002 * only relevant for frames that do not have data present, and is
1003 * also not used for 802.3 format frames. Note that even if the frame
1004 * is on a specific link, address translation might still apply if
1005 * it's intended for an MLD.
1006 *
1007 * These flags are used in tx_info->control.flags.
1008 */
1009 enum mac80211_tx_control_flags {
1010 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO = BIT(0),
1011 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE = BIT(1),
1012 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT = BIT(2),
1013 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU = BIT(3),
1014 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT = BIT(4),
1015 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP = BIT(5),
1016 IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING = BIT(6),
1017 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO = BIT(7),
1018 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER = BIT(8),
1019 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX = BIT(9),
1020 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_USE_RATE_MASK = BIT(10),
1021 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK = 0xf0000000,
1022 };
1023
1024 #define IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED 0xf
1025 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK_UNSPEC \
1026 u32_encode_bits(IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, \
1027 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK)
1028
1029 /**
1030 * enum mac80211_tx_status_flags - flags to describe transmit status
1031 *
1032 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID: ACK signal is valid
1033 *
1034 * These flags are used in tx_info->status.flags.
1035 */
1036 enum mac80211_tx_status_flags {
1037 IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID = BIT(0),
1038 };
1039
1040 /*
1041 * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are
1042 * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack.
1043 */
1044 #define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK | \
1045 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT | \
1046 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU | \
1047 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK | \
1048 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK | \
1049 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER | \
1050 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC | \
1051 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC | IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
1052
1053 /**
1054 * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the
1055 * Rate Control algorithm.
1056 *
1057 * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx,
1058 * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate.
1059 *
1060 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate.
1061 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required.
1062 * This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection.
1063 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble.
1064 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate.
1065 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS: VHT MCS rate, in this case the idx field is split
1066 * into a higher 4 bits (Nss) and lower 4 bits (MCS number)
1067 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in
1068 * Greenfield mode.
1069 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz.
1070 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 80 MHz transmission
1071 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 160 MHz transmission
1072 * (80+80 isn't supported yet)
1073 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the
1074 * adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is
1075 * NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS.
1076 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate.
1077 */
1078 enum mac80211_rate_control_flags {
1079 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS = BIT(0),
1080 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT = BIT(1),
1081 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE = BIT(2),
1082
1083 /* rate index is an HT/VHT MCS instead of an index */
1084 IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS = BIT(3),
1085 IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD = BIT(4),
1086 IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(5),
1087 IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA = BIT(6),
1088 IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI = BIT(7),
1089 IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS = BIT(8),
1090 IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(9),
1091 IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(10),
1092 };
1093
1094
1095 /* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */
1096 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40
1097
1098 /* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */
1099 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24
1100
1101 /* maximum number of rate stages */
1102 #define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES 4
1103
1104 /* maximum number of rate table entries */
1105 #define IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE 4
1106
1107 /**
1108 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status
1109 *
1110 * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with
1111 * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags)
1112 * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate
1113 *
1114 * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used
1115 * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried.
1116 *
1117 * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should
1118 * always report the rate along with the flags it used.
1119 *
1120 * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs
1121 * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate
1122 * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example,
1123 * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the
1124 * information::
1125 *
1126 * { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 }
1127 *
1128 * then this means that the frame should be transmitted
1129 * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four
1130 * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets
1131 * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status
1132 * information should then contain::
1133 *
1134 * { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ...
1135 *
1136 * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2
1137 * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement.
1138 */
1139 struct ieee80211_tx_rate {
1140 s8 idx;
1141 u16 count:5,
1142 flags:11;
1143 } __packed;
1144
1145 #define IEEE80211_MAX_TX_RETRY 31
1146
ieee80211_rate_valid(struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate)1147 static inline bool ieee80211_rate_valid(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1148 {
1149 return rate->idx >= 0 && rate->count > 0;
1150 }
1151
ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate,u8 mcs,u8 nss)1152 static inline void ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate,
1153 u8 mcs, u8 nss)
1154 {
1155 WARN_ON(mcs & ~0xF);
1156 WARN_ON((nss - 1) & ~0x7);
1157 rate->idx = ((nss - 1) << 4) | mcs;
1158 }
1159
1160 static inline u8
ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate)1161 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1162 {
1163 return rate->idx & 0xF;
1164 }
1165
1166 static inline u8
ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate)1167 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1168 {
1169 return (rate->idx >> 4) + 1;
1170 }
1171
1172 /**
1173 * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information
1174 *
1175 * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses:
1176 * (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do
1177 * (2) driver internal use (if applicable)
1178 * (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened
1179 *
1180 * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above
1181 * @band: the band to transmit on (use e.g. for checking for races),
1182 * not valid if the interface is an MLD since we won't know which
1183 * link the frame will be transmitted on
1184 * @hw_queue: HW queue to put the frame on, skb_get_queue_mapping() gives the AC
1185 * @status_data: internal data for TX status handling, assigned privately,
1186 * see also &enum ieee80211_status_data for the internal documentation
1187 * @status_data_idr: indicates status data is IDR allocated ID for ack frame
1188 * @tx_time_est: TX time estimate in units of 4us, used internally
1189 * @control: union part for control data
1190 * @control.rates: TX rates array to try
1191 * @control.rts_cts_rate_idx: rate for RTS or CTS
1192 * @control.use_rts: use RTS
1193 * @control.use_cts_prot: use RTS/CTS
1194 * @control.short_preamble: use short preamble (CCK only)
1195 * @control.skip_table: skip externally configured rate table
1196 * @control.jiffies: timestamp for expiry on powersave clients
1197 * @control.vif: virtual interface (may be NULL)
1198 * @control.hw_key: key to encrypt with (may be NULL)
1199 * @control.flags: control flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_control_flags
1200 * @control.enqueue_time: enqueue time (for iTXQs)
1201 * @driver_rates: alias to @control.rates to reserve space
1202 * @pad: padding
1203 * @rate_driver_data: driver use area if driver needs @control.rates
1204 * @status: union part for status data
1205 * @status.rates: attempted rates
1206 * @status.ack_signal: ACK signal
1207 * @status.ampdu_ack_len: AMPDU ack length
1208 * @status.ampdu_len: AMPDU length
1209 * @status.antenna: (legacy, kept only for iwlegacy)
1210 * @status.tx_time: airtime consumed for transmission; note this is only
1211 * used for WMM AC, not for airtime fairness
1212 * @status.flags: status flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_status_flags
1213 * @status.status_driver_data: driver use area
1214 * @ack: union part for pure ACK data
1215 * @ack.cookie: cookie for the ACK
1216 * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers
1217 */
1218 struct ieee80211_tx_info {
1219 /* common information */
1220 u32 flags;
1221 u32 band:3,
1222 status_data_idr:1,
1223 status_data:13,
1224 hw_queue:4,
1225 tx_time_est:10;
1226 /* 1 free bit */
1227
1228 union {
1229 struct {
1230 union {
1231 /* rate control */
1232 struct {
1233 struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[
1234 IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1235 s8 rts_cts_rate_idx;
1236 u8 use_rts:1;
1237 u8 use_cts_prot:1;
1238 u8 short_preamble:1;
1239 u8 skip_table:1;
1240
1241 /* for injection only (bitmap) */
1242 u8 antennas:2;
1243
1244 /* 14 bits free */
1245 };
1246 /* only needed before rate control */
1247 unsigned long jiffies;
1248 };
1249 /* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */
1250 struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
1251 struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key;
1252 u32 flags;
1253 codel_time_t enqueue_time;
1254 } control;
1255 struct {
1256 u64 cookie;
1257 } ack;
1258 struct {
1259 struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1260 s32 ack_signal;
1261 u8 ampdu_ack_len;
1262 u8 ampdu_len;
1263 u8 antenna;
1264 u8 pad;
1265 u16 tx_time;
1266 u8 flags;
1267 u8 pad2;
1268 void *status_driver_data[16 / sizeof(void *)];
1269 } status;
1270 struct {
1271 struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[
1272 IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1273 u8 pad[4];
1274
1275 void *rate_driver_data[
1276 IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1277 };
1278 void *driver_data[
1279 IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1280 };
1281 };
1282
1283 static inline u16
ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info,u16 tx_time_est)1284 ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, u16 tx_time_est)
1285 {
1286 /* We only have 10 bits in tx_time_est, so store airtime
1287 * in increments of 4us and clamp the maximum to 2**12-1
1288 */
1289 info->tx_time_est = min_t(u16, tx_time_est, 4095) >> 2;
1290 return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1291 }
1292
1293 static inline u16
ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)1294 ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1295 {
1296 return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1297 }
1298
1299 /***
1300 * struct ieee80211_rate_status - mrr stage for status path
1301 *
1302 * This struct is used in struct ieee80211_tx_status to provide drivers a
1303 * dynamic way to report about used rates and power levels per packet.
1304 *
1305 * @rate_idx The actual used rate.
1306 * @try_count How often the rate was tried.
1307 * @tx_power_idx An idx into the ieee80211_hw->tx_power_levels list of the
1308 * corresponding wifi hardware. The idx shall point to the power level
1309 * that was used when sending the packet.
1310 */
1311 struct ieee80211_rate_status {
1312 struct rate_info rate_idx;
1313 u8 try_count;
1314 u8 tx_power_idx;
1315 };
1316
1317 /**
1318 * struct ieee80211_tx_status - extended tx status info for rate control
1319 *
1320 * @sta: Station that the packet was transmitted for
1321 * @info: Basic tx status information
1322 * @skb: Packet skb (can be NULL if not provided by the driver)
1323 * @rates: Mrr stages that were used when sending the packet
1324 * @n_rates: Number of mrr stages (count of instances for @rates)
1325 * @free_list: list where processed skbs are stored to be free'd by the driver
1326 * @ack_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp of the received ack in nanoseconds
1327 * Only needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action
1328 * frames. Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1329 */
1330 struct ieee80211_tx_status {
1331 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
1332 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info;
1333 struct sk_buff *skb;
1334 struct ieee80211_rate_status *rates;
1335 ktime_t ack_hwtstamp;
1336 u8 n_rates;
1337
1338 struct list_head *free_list;
1339 };
1340
1341 /**
1342 * struct ieee80211_scan_ies - descriptors for different blocks of IEs
1343 *
1344 * This structure is used to point to different blocks of IEs in HW scan
1345 * and scheduled scan. These blocks contain the IEs passed by userspace
1346 * and the ones generated by mac80211.
1347 *
1348 * @ies: pointers to band specific IEs.
1349 * @len: lengths of band_specific IEs.
1350 * @common_ies: IEs for all bands (especially vendor specific ones)
1351 * @common_ie_len: length of the common_ies
1352 */
1353 struct ieee80211_scan_ies {
1354 const u8 *ies[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1355 size_t len[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1356 const u8 *common_ies;
1357 size_t common_ie_len;
1358 };
1359
1360
IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff * skb)1361 static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1362 {
1363 return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb;
1364 }
1365
IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff * skb)1366 static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1367 {
1368 return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb;
1369 }
1370
1371 /**
1372 * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status
1373 *
1374 * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared.
1375 *
1376 * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report
1377 * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything
1378 * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear
1379 * the count since you need to fill that in anyway).
1380 *
1381 * NOTE: While the rates array is kept intact, this will wipe all of the
1382 * driver_data fields in info, so it's up to the driver to restore
1383 * any fields it needs after calling this helper.
1384 */
1385 static inline void
ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)1386 ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1387 {
1388 int i;
1389
1390 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1391 offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates));
1392 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1393 offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates));
1394 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8);
1395 /* clear the rate counts */
1396 for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++)
1397 info->status.rates[i].count = 0;
1398 memset_after(&info->status, 0, rates);
1399 }
1400
1401
1402 /**
1403 * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags
1404 *
1405 * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status.
1406 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame.
1407 * Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED.
1408 * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware.
1409 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame,
1410 * verification has been done by the hardware.
1411 * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV and ICV are stripped from this frame.
1412 * If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection
1413 * hence the driver or hardware will have to do that.
1414 * @RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED: Currently only valid for CCMP/GCMP frames, this
1415 * flag indicates that the PN was verified for replay protection.
1416 * Note that this flag is also currently only supported when a frame
1417 * is also decrypted (ie. @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED must be set)
1418 * @RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED: The driver should set this flag if it did
1419 * de-duplication by itself.
1420 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on
1421 * the frame.
1422 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on
1423 * the frame.
1424 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1425 * field) is valid if this field is non-zero, and the position
1426 * where the timestamp was sampled depends on the value.
1427 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1428 * field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU
1429 * was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS
1430 * merging.
1431 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1432 * field) is valid and contains the time the last symbol of the MPDU
1433 * (including FCS) was received.
1434 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1435 * field) is valid and contains the time the SYNC preamble was received.
1436 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_IS_RTAP_TS64: The timestamp passed in the RX status @mactime
1437 * is only for use in the radiotap timestamp header, not otherwise a valid
1438 * @mactime value. Note this is a separate flag so that we continue to see
1439 * %RX_FLAG_MACTIME as unset. Also note that in this case the timestamp is
1440 * reported to be 64 bits wide, not just 32.
1441 * @RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL: The signal strength value is not present.
1442 * Valid only for data frames (mainly A-MPDU)
1443 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS: A-MPDU details are known, in particular the reference
1444 * number (@ampdu_reference) must be populated and be a distinct number for
1445 * each A-MPDU
1446 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN: last subframe is known, should be set on all
1447 * subframes of a single A-MPDU
1448 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST: this subframe is the last subframe of the A-MPDU
1449 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR: A delimiter CRC error has been detected
1450 * on this subframe
1451 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN: The delimiter CRC field is known (the CRC
1452 * is stored in the @ampdu_delimiter_crc field)
1453 * @RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED: The mic was stripped of this packet. Decryption was
1454 * done by the hardware
1455 * @RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR: Report frame only to monitor interfaces without
1456 * processing it in any regular way.
1457 * This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1458 * them for sniffing purposes.
1459 * @RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR: Process and report frame to all interfaces except
1460 * monitor interfaces.
1461 * This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1462 * them for sniffing purposes.
1463 * @RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE: Some drivers may prefer to report separate A-MSDU
1464 * subframes instead of a one huge frame for performance reasons.
1465 * All, but the last MSDU from an A-MSDU should have this flag set. E.g.
1466 * if an A-MSDU has 3 frames, the first 2 must have the flag set, while
1467 * the 3rd (last) one must not have this flag set. The flag is used to
1468 * deal with retransmission/duplication recovery properly since A-MSDU
1469 * subframes share the same sequence number. Reported subframes can be
1470 * either regular MSDU or singly A-MSDUs. Subframes must not be
1471 * interleaved with other frames.
1472 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END: This frame contains radiotap TLVs in the
1473 * skb->data (before the 802.11 header).
1474 * If used, the SKB's mac_header pointer must be set to point
1475 * to the 802.11 header after the TLVs, and any padding added after TLV
1476 * data to align to 4 must be cleared by the driver putting the TLVs
1477 * in the skb.
1478 * @RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN: Allow the same PN as same packet before.
1479 * This is used for AMSDU subframes which can have the same PN as
1480 * the first subframe.
1481 * @RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED: The ICV is stripped from this frame. CRC checking must
1482 * be done in the hardware.
1483 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT: Value of the EOF bit in the A-MPDU delimiter for this
1484 * frame
1485 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN: The EOF value is known
1486 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE: HE radiotap data is present
1487 * (&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he, mac80211 will fill in
1488 *
1489 * - DATA3_DATA_MCS
1490 * - DATA3_DATA_DCM
1491 * - DATA3_CODING
1492 * - DATA5_GI
1493 * - DATA5_DATA_BW_RU_ALLOC
1494 * - DATA6_NSTS
1495 * - DATA3_STBC
1496 *
1497 * from the RX info data, so leave those zeroed when building this data)
1498 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU: HE MU radiotap data is present
1499 * (&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he_mu)
1500 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG: L-SIG radiotap data is present
1501 * @RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU: use the frame only for radiotap reporting, with
1502 * the "0-length PSDU" field included there. The value for it is
1503 * in &struct ieee80211_rx_status. Note that if this value isn't
1504 * known the frame shouldn't be reported.
1505 * @RX_FLAG_8023: the frame has an 802.3 header (decap offload performed by
1506 * hardware or driver)
1507 */
1508 enum mac80211_rx_flags {
1509 RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR = BIT(0),
1510 RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED = BIT(1),
1511 RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR = BIT(2),
1512 RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED = BIT(3),
1513 RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED = BIT(4),
1514 RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC = BIT(5),
1515 RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC = BIT(6),
1516 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_IS_RTAP_TS64 = BIT(7),
1517 RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL = BIT(8),
1518 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS = BIT(9),
1519 RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED = BIT(10),
1520 RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED = BIT(11),
1521 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN = BIT(12),
1522 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST = BIT(13),
1523 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR = BIT(14),
1524 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN = BIT(15),
1525 RX_FLAG_MACTIME = BIT(16) | BIT(17),
1526 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START = 1 << 16,
1527 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START = 2 << 16,
1528 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END = 3 << 16,
1529 RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR = BIT(18),
1530 RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE = BIT(19),
1531 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END = BIT(20),
1532 RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED = BIT(21),
1533 RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN = BIT(22),
1534 RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED = BIT(23),
1535 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT = BIT(24),
1536 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN = BIT(25),
1537 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE = BIT(26),
1538 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU = BIT(27),
1539 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG = BIT(28),
1540 RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU = BIT(29),
1541 RX_FLAG_8023 = BIT(30),
1542 };
1543
1544 /**
1545 * enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags - MCS & bandwidth flags
1546 *
1547 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame
1548 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used
1549 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF: This frame was received in a HT-greenfield transmission,
1550 * if the driver fills this value it should add
1551 * %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_FMT
1552 * to @hw.radiotap_mcs_details to advertise that fact.
1553 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC: LDPC was used
1554 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK: STBC 2 bit bitmask. 1 - Nss=1, 2 - Nss=2, 3 - Nss=3
1555 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_BF: packet was beamformed
1556 */
1557 enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags {
1558 RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE = BIT(0),
1559 RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI = BIT(2),
1560 RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF = BIT(3),
1561 RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK = BIT(4) | BIT(5),
1562 RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC = BIT(6),
1563 RX_ENC_FLAG_BF = BIT(7),
1564 };
1565
1566 #define RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_SHIFT 4
1567
1568 enum mac80211_rx_encoding {
1569 RX_ENC_LEGACY = 0,
1570 RX_ENC_HT,
1571 RX_ENC_VHT,
1572 RX_ENC_HE,
1573 RX_ENC_EHT,
1574 };
1575
1576 /**
1577 * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status
1578 *
1579 * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset
1580 * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received
1581 * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb).
1582 *
1583 * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function
1584 * (TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware.
1585 * @boottime_ns: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp the frame was received at, this is
1586 * needed only for beacons and probe responses that update the scan cache.
1587 * @ack_tx_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp for the ack TX in nanoseconds. Only
1588 * needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action frames.
1589 * Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1590 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, mac80211 doesn't use
1591 * it but can store it and pass it back to the driver for synchronisation
1592 * @band: the active band when this frame was received
1593 * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz
1594 * This field must be set for management frames, but isn't strictly needed
1595 * for data (other) frames - for those it only affects radiotap reporting.
1596 * @freq_offset: @freq has a positive offset of 500Khz.
1597 * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or
1598 * unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags
1599 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_*
1600 * @chains: bitmask of receive chains for which separate signal strength
1601 * values were filled.
1602 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength, in dBm (unlike @signal, doesn't
1603 * support dB or unspecified units)
1604 * @antenna: antenna used
1605 * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if
1606 * HT or VHT is used (%RX_FLAG_HT/%RX_FLAG_VHT)
1607 * @nss: number of streams (VHT, HE and EHT only)
1608 * @flag: %RX_FLAG_\*
1609 * @encoding: &enum mac80211_rx_encoding
1610 * @bw: &enum rate_info_bw
1611 * @enc_flags: uses bits from &enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags
1612 * @he_ru: HE RU, from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc
1613 * @he_gi: HE GI, from &enum nl80211_he_gi
1614 * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1615 * @eht: EHT specific rate information
1616 * @eht.ru: EHT RU, from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc
1617 * @eht.gi: EHT GI, from &enum nl80211_eht_gi
1618 * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211
1619 * @ampdu_reference: A-MPDU reference number, must be a different value for
1620 * each A-MPDU but the same for each subframe within one A-MPDU
1621 * @ampdu_delimiter_crc: A-MPDU delimiter CRC
1622 * @zero_length_psdu_type: radiotap type of the 0-length PSDU
1623 * @link_valid: if the link which is identified by @link_id is valid. This flag
1624 * is set only when connection is MLO.
1625 * @link_id: id of the link used to receive the packet. This is used along with
1626 * @link_valid.
1627 */
1628 struct ieee80211_rx_status {
1629 u64 mactime;
1630 union {
1631 u64 boottime_ns;
1632 ktime_t ack_tx_hwtstamp;
1633 };
1634 u32 device_timestamp;
1635 u32 ampdu_reference;
1636 u32 flag;
1637 u16 freq: 13, freq_offset: 1;
1638 u8 enc_flags;
1639 u8 encoding:3, bw:4;
1640 union {
1641 struct {
1642 u8 he_ru:3;
1643 u8 he_gi:2;
1644 u8 he_dcm:1;
1645 };
1646 struct {
1647 u8 ru:4;
1648 u8 gi:2;
1649 } eht;
1650 };
1651 u8 rate_idx;
1652 u8 nss;
1653 u8 rx_flags;
1654 u8 band;
1655 u8 antenna;
1656 s8 signal;
1657 u8 chains;
1658 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1659 u8 ampdu_delimiter_crc;
1660 u8 zero_length_psdu_type;
1661 u8 link_valid:1, link_id:4;
1662 };
1663
1664 static inline u32
ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status * rx_status)1665 ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status *rx_status)
1666 {
1667 return MHZ_TO_KHZ(rx_status->freq) +
1668 (rx_status->freq_offset ? 500 : 0);
1669 }
1670
1671 /**
1672 * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags
1673 *
1674 * Flags to define PHY configuration options
1675 *
1676 * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this
1677 * to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets
1678 * or not, do not use instead of filter flags!
1679 * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only).
1680 * This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2,
1681 * meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to
1682 * transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames.
1683 * Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states,
1684 * driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support"
1685 * for more.
1686 * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set
1687 * the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but
1688 * may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will
1689 * be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but
1690 * it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active.
1691 * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main
1692 * operating channel.
1693 */
1694 enum ieee80211_conf_flags {
1695 IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR = (1<<0),
1696 IEEE80211_CONF_PS = (1<<1),
1697 IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE = (1<<2),
1698 IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL = (1<<3),
1699 };
1700
1701
1702 /**
1703 * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed
1704 *
1705 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed
1706 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed
1707 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed
1708 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed
1709 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed
1710 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed
1711 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed
1712 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed
1713 * Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1714 * otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1715 */
1716 enum ieee80211_conf_changed {
1717 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS = BIT(1),
1718 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL = BIT(2),
1719 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR = BIT(3),
1720 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS = BIT(4),
1721 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER = BIT(5),
1722 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL = BIT(6),
1723 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS = BIT(7),
1724 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE = BIT(8),
1725 };
1726
1727 /**
1728 * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode
1729 *
1730 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic
1731 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off
1732 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static
1733 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic
1734 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use
1735 */
1736 enum ieee80211_smps_mode {
1737 IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC,
1738 IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF,
1739 IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC,
1740 IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
1741
1742 /* keep last */
1743 IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES,
1744 };
1745
1746 /**
1747 * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device
1748 *
1749 * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware.
1750 *
1751 * @flags: configuration flags defined above
1752 *
1753 * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval
1754 * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use
1755 * in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon
1756 * has been received and the DTIM period is known.
1757 * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the
1758 * powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when
1759 * the CONF_PS flag is set.
1760 *
1761 * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm), backward compatibility
1762 * value only that is set to the minimum of all interfaces
1763 *
1764 * @chandef: the channel definition to tune to
1765 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled
1766 *
1767 * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame
1768 * (a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11,
1769 * but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries
1770 * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short"
1771 * frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the
1772 * number of transmissions not the number of retries
1773 *
1774 * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that
1775 * %IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not
1776 * configured for an HT channel.
1777 * Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1778 * otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1779 */
1780 struct ieee80211_conf {
1781 u32 flags;
1782 int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout;
1783
1784 u16 listen_interval;
1785 u8 ps_dtim_period;
1786
1787 u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count;
1788
1789 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1790 bool radar_enabled;
1791 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1792 };
1793
1794 /**
1795 * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data
1796 *
1797 * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch
1798 * operation.
1799 *
1800 * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization
1801 * Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch
1802 * announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter
1803 * the driver passed into mac80211.
1804 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, this is the
1805 * rx.device_timestamp parameter the driver passed to mac80211.
1806 * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the
1807 * scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP.
1808 * @chandef: the new channel to switch to
1809 * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event
1810 * @delay: maximum delay between the time the AP transmitted the last beacon in
1811 * current channel and the expected time of the first beacon in the new
1812 * channel, expressed in TU.
1813 * @link_id: the link ID of the link doing the channel switch, 0 for non-MLO
1814 */
1815 struct ieee80211_channel_switch {
1816 u64 timestamp;
1817 u32 device_timestamp;
1818 bool block_tx;
1819 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1820 u8 count;
1821 u8 link_id;
1822 u32 delay;
1823 };
1824
1825 /**
1826 * enum ieee80211_vif_flags - virtual interface flags
1827 *
1828 * @IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER: the device performs beacon filtering
1829 * on this virtual interface to avoid unnecessary CPU wakeups
1830 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI: the device can do connection quality
1831 * monitoring on this virtual interface -- i.e. it can monitor
1832 * connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and
1833 * provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached.
1834 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD: The device can do U-APSD for this
1835 * interface. This flag should be set during interface addition,
1836 * but may be set/cleared as late as authentication to an AP. It is
1837 * only valid for managed/station mode interfaces.
1838 * @IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE: request to handle NOA attributes
1839 * and send P2P_PS notification to the driver if NOA changed, even
1840 * this is not pure P2P vif.
1841 * @IEEE80211_VIF_EML_ACTIVE: The driver indicates that EML operation is
1842 * enabled for the interface.
1843 * @IEEE80211_VIF_IGNORE_OFDMA_WIDER_BW: Ignore wider bandwidth OFDMA
1844 * operation on this interface and request a channel context without
1845 * the AP definition. Use this e.g. because the device is able to
1846 * handle OFDMA (downlink and trigger for uplink) on a per-AP basis.
1847 */
1848 enum ieee80211_vif_flags {
1849 IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER = BIT(0),
1850 IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI = BIT(1),
1851 IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD = BIT(2),
1852 IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE = BIT(3),
1853 IEEE80211_VIF_EML_ACTIVE = BIT(4),
1854 IEEE80211_VIF_IGNORE_OFDMA_WIDER_BW = BIT(5),
1855 };
1856
1857
1858 /**
1859 * enum ieee80211_offload_flags - virtual interface offload flags
1860 *
1861 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED: tx encapsulation offload is enabled
1862 * The driver supports sending frames passed as 802.3 frames by mac80211.
1863 * It must also support sending 802.11 packets for the same interface.
1864 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR: support 4-address mode encapsulation offload
1865 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED: rx encapsulation offload is enabled
1866 * The driver supports passing received 802.11 frames as 802.3 frames to
1867 * mac80211.
1868 */
1869
1870 enum ieee80211_offload_flags {
1871 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED = BIT(0),
1872 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR = BIT(1),
1873 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED = BIT(2),
1874 };
1875
1876 /**
1877 * struct ieee80211_vif_cfg - interface configuration
1878 * @assoc: association status
1879 * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS or not
1880 * @ibss_creator: indicates if a new IBSS network is being created
1881 * @ps: power-save mode (STA only). This flag is NOT affected by
1882 * offchannel/dynamic_ps operations.
1883 * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true
1884 * @eml_cap: EML capabilities as described in P802.11be_D4.1 Figure 9-1001j.
1885 * @eml_med_sync_delay: Medium Synchronization delay as described in
1886 * P802.11be_D4.1 Figure 9-1001i.
1887 * @mld_capa_op: MLD Capabilities and Operations per P802.11be_D4.1
1888 * Figure 9-1001k
1889 * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The
1890 * may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here.
1891 * The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here
1892 * to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass.
1893 * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list. Note that this
1894 * may be larger than %IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN (the arp_addr_list
1895 * array size), it's up to the driver what to do in that case.
1896 * @ssid: The SSID of the current vif. Valid in AP and IBSS mode.
1897 * @ssid_len: Length of SSID given in @ssid.
1898 * @s1g: BSS is S1G BSS (affects Association Request format).
1899 * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the
1900 * hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what
1901 * your driver/device needs to do.
1902 * @ap_addr: AP MLD address, or BSSID for non-MLO connections
1903 * (station mode only)
1904 */
1905 struct ieee80211_vif_cfg {
1906 /* association related data */
1907 bool assoc, ibss_joined;
1908 bool ibss_creator;
1909 bool ps;
1910 u16 aid;
1911 u16 eml_cap;
1912 u16 eml_med_sync_delay;
1913 u16 mld_capa_op;
1914
1915 __be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN];
1916 int arp_addr_cnt;
1917 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
1918 size_t ssid_len;
1919 bool s1g;
1920 bool idle;
1921 u8 ap_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1922 };
1923
1924 #define IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS 8
1925
1926 /**
1927 * struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm - negotiated TID to link map info
1928 *
1929 * @downlink: bitmap of active links per TID for downlink, or 0 if mapping for
1930 * this TID is not included.
1931 * @uplink: bitmap of active links per TID for uplink, or 0 if mapping for this
1932 * TID is not included.
1933 * @valid: info is valid or not.
1934 */
1935 struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm {
1936 u16 downlink[IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS];
1937 u16 uplink[IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS];
1938 bool valid;
1939 };
1940
1941 /**
1942 * enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res - return value for negotiated TTLM handling
1943 * @NEG_TTLM_RES_ACCEPT: accept the request
1944 * @NEG_TTLM_RES_REJECT: reject the request
1945 * @NEG_TTLM_RES_SUGGEST_PREFERRED: reject and suggest a new mapping
1946 */
1947 enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res {
1948 NEG_TTLM_RES_ACCEPT,
1949 NEG_TTLM_RES_REJECT,
1950 NEG_TTLM_RES_SUGGEST_PREFERRED
1951 };
1952
1953 /**
1954 * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data
1955 *
1956 * Data in this structure is continually present for driver
1957 * use during the life of a virtual interface.
1958 *
1959 * @type: type of this virtual interface
1960 * @cfg: vif configuration, see &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg
1961 * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own
1962 * or the BSS we're associated to
1963 * @link_conf: in case of MLD, the per-link BSS configuration,
1964 * indexed by link ID
1965 * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1966 * @active_links: The bitmap of active links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1967 * The driver shouldn't change this directly, but use the
1968 * API calls meant for that purpose.
1969 * @dormant_links: subset of the valid links that are disabled/suspended
1970 * due to advertised or negotiated TTLM respectively.
1971 * 0 for non-MLO.
1972 * @suspended_links: subset of dormant_links representing links that are
1973 * suspended due to negotiated TTLM, and could be activated in the
1974 * future by tearing down the TTLM negotiation.
1975 * 0 for non-MLO.
1976 * @neg_ttlm: negotiated TID to link mapping info.
1977 * see &struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm.
1978 * @addr: address of this interface
1979 * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p
1980 * interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively
1981 * @netdev_features: tx netdev features supported by the hardware for this
1982 * vif. mac80211 initializes this to hw->netdev_features, and the driver
1983 * can mask out specific tx features. mac80211 will handle software fixup
1984 * for masked offloads (GSO, CSUM)
1985 * @driver_flags: flags/capabilities the driver has for this interface,
1986 * these need to be set (or cleared) when the interface is added
1987 * or, if supported by the driver, the interface type is changed
1988 * at runtime, mac80211 will never touch this field
1989 * @offload_flags: hardware offload capabilities/flags for this interface.
1990 * These are initialized by mac80211 before calling .add_interface,
1991 * .change_interface or .update_vif_offload and updated by the driver
1992 * within these ops, based on supported features or runtime change
1993 * restrictions.
1994 * @hw_queue: hardware queue for each AC
1995 * @cab_queue: content-after-beacon (DTIM beacon really) queue, AP mode only
1996 * @debugfs_dir: debugfs dentry, can be used by drivers to create own per
1997 * interface debug files. Note that it will be NULL for the virtual
1998 * monitor interface (if that is requested.)
1999 * @probe_req_reg: probe requests should be reported to mac80211 for this
2000 * interface.
2001 * @rx_mcast_action_reg: multicast Action frames should be reported to mac80211
2002 * for this interface.
2003 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
2004 * sizeof(void \*).
2005 * @txq: the multicast data TX queue
2006 * @offload_flags: 802.3 -> 802.11 enapsulation offload flags, see
2007 * &enum ieee80211_offload_flags.
2008 * @mbssid_tx_vif: Pointer to the transmitting interface if MBSSID is enabled.
2009 */
2010 struct ieee80211_vif {
2011 enum nl80211_iftype type;
2012 struct ieee80211_vif_cfg cfg;
2013 struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf;
2014 struct ieee80211_bss_conf __rcu *link_conf[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
2015 u16 valid_links, active_links, dormant_links, suspended_links;
2016 struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm neg_ttlm;
2017 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2018 bool p2p;
2019
2020 u8 cab_queue;
2021 u8 hw_queue[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS];
2022
2023 struct ieee80211_txq *txq;
2024
2025 netdev_features_t netdev_features;
2026 u32 driver_flags;
2027 u32 offload_flags;
2028
2029 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
2030 struct dentry *debugfs_dir;
2031 #endif
2032
2033 bool probe_req_reg;
2034 bool rx_mcast_action_reg;
2035
2036 struct ieee80211_vif *mbssid_tx_vif;
2037
2038 /* must be last */
2039 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2040 };
2041
2042 /**
2043 * ieee80211_vif_usable_links - Return the usable links for the vif
2044 * @vif: the vif for which the usable links are requested
2045 * Return: the usable link bitmap
2046 */
ieee80211_vif_usable_links(const struct ieee80211_vif * vif)2047 static inline u16 ieee80211_vif_usable_links(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2048 {
2049 return vif->valid_links & ~vif->dormant_links;
2050 }
2051
2052 /**
2053 * ieee80211_vif_is_mld - Returns true iff the vif is an MLD one
2054 * @vif: the vif
2055 * Return: %true if the vif is an MLD, %false otherwise.
2056 */
ieee80211_vif_is_mld(const struct ieee80211_vif * vif)2057 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mld(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2058 {
2059 /* valid_links != 0 indicates this vif is an MLD */
2060 return vif->valid_links != 0;
2061 }
2062
2063 /**
2064 * ieee80211_vif_link_active - check if a given link is active
2065 * @vif: the vif
2066 * @link_id: the link ID to check
2067 * Return: %true if the vif is an MLD and the link is active, or if
2068 * the vif is not an MLD and the link ID is 0; %false otherwise.
2069 */
ieee80211_vif_link_active(const struct ieee80211_vif * vif,unsigned int link_id)2070 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_link_active(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
2071 unsigned int link_id)
2072 {
2073 if (!ieee80211_vif_is_mld(vif))
2074 return link_id == 0;
2075 return vif->active_links & BIT(link_id);
2076 }
2077
2078 #define for_each_vif_active_link(vif, link, link_id) \
2079 for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((vif)->link_conf); link_id++) \
2080 if ((!(vif)->active_links || \
2081 (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) && \
2082 (link = link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id)))
2083
ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)2084 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2085 {
2086 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH
2087 return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT;
2088 #endif
2089 return false;
2090 }
2091
2092 /**
2093 * wdev_to_ieee80211_vif - return a vif struct from a wdev
2094 * @wdev: the wdev to get the vif for
2095 *
2096 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
2097 * (like the vendor commands) that get a wdev.
2098 *
2099 * Return: pointer to the wdev, or %NULL if the given wdev isn't
2100 * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor
2101 * or AP_VLAN interfaces.)
2102 */
2103 struct ieee80211_vif *wdev_to_ieee80211_vif(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
2104
2105 /**
2106 * ieee80211_vif_to_wdev - return a wdev struct from a vif
2107 * @vif: the vif to get the wdev for
2108 *
2109 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
2110 * (like the vendor commands) that needs to get the wdev for a vif.
2111 * This can also be useful to get the netdev associated to a vif.
2112 *
2113 * Return: pointer to the wdev
2114 */
2115 struct wireless_dev *ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
2116
lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)2117 static inline bool lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2118 {
2119 return lockdep_is_held(&ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(vif)->wiphy->mtx);
2120 }
2121
2122 #define link_conf_dereference_protected(vif, link_id) \
2123 rcu_dereference_protected((vif)->link_conf[link_id], \
2124 lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(vif))
2125
2126 #define link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id) \
2127 rcu_dereference_check((vif)->link_conf[link_id], \
2128 lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(vif))
2129
2130 /**
2131 * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags
2132 *
2133 * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver
2134 * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf.
2135 *
2136 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the
2137 * driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this
2138 * particular key. Setting this flag does not necessarily mean that SKBs
2139 * will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or MIC.
2140 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by
2141 * the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC
2142 * generation in software.
2143 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates
2144 * that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key.
2145 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX: This flag should be set by the driver for a
2146 * CCMP/GCMP key if it requires CCMP/GCMP encryption of management frames
2147 * (MFP) to be done in software.
2148 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver
2149 * if space should be prepared for the IV, but the IV
2150 * itself should not be generated. Do not set together with
2151 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV on the same key. Setting this flag does
2152 * not necessarily mean that SKBs will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or
2153 * MIC.
2154 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT: This key will be used to decrypt received
2155 * management frames. The flag can help drivers that have a hardware
2156 * crypto implementation that doesn't deal with management frames
2157 * properly by allowing them to not upload the keys to hardware and
2158 * fall back to software crypto. Note that this flag deals only with
2159 * RX, if your crypto engine can't deal with TX you can also set the
2160 * %IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX flag to encrypt such frames in SW.
2161 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT: This flag should be set by the
2162 * driver for a CCMP/GCMP key to indicate that is requires IV generation
2163 * only for management frames (MFP).
2164 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM: This flag should be set by the
2165 * driver for a key to indicate that sufficient tailroom must always
2166 * be reserved for ICV or MIC, even when HW encryption is enabled.
2167 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver for
2168 * a TKIP key if it only requires MIC space. Do not set together with
2169 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC on the same key.
2170 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX: Key needs explicit Tx activation.
2171 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE: This flag should be set by the driver
2172 * for a AES_CMAC or a AES_GMAC key to indicate that it requires sequence
2173 * number generation only
2174 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU: SPP A-MSDUs can be used with this key
2175 * (set by mac80211 from the sta->spp_amsdu flag)
2176 */
2177 enum ieee80211_key_flags {
2178 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT = BIT(0),
2179 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV = BIT(1),
2180 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC = BIT(2),
2181 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE = BIT(3),
2182 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX = BIT(4),
2183 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE = BIT(5),
2184 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT = BIT(6),
2185 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM = BIT(7),
2186 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE = BIT(8),
2187 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX = BIT(9),
2188 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE = BIT(10),
2189 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU = BIT(11),
2190 };
2191
2192 /**
2193 * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information
2194 *
2195 * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by
2196 * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops.
2197 *
2198 * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver
2199 * wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be
2200 * encrypted in hardware.
2201 * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector.
2202 * @tx_pn: PN used for TX keys, may be used by the driver as well if it
2203 * needs to do software PN assignment by itself (e.g. due to TSO)
2204 * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags.
2205 * @keyidx: the key index (0-3)
2206 * @keylen: key material length
2207 * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte)
2208 * data block:
2209 * - Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits)
2210 * - Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits)
2211 * - Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits)
2212 * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type
2213 * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type
2214 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, or -1 for non-MLO or pairwise keys
2215 */
2216 struct ieee80211_key_conf {
2217 atomic64_t tx_pn;
2218 u32 cipher;
2219 u8 icv_len;
2220 u8 iv_len;
2221 u8 hw_key_idx;
2222 s8 keyidx;
2223 u16 flags;
2224 s8 link_id;
2225 u8 keylen;
2226 u8 key[];
2227 };
2228
2229 #define IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN 16
2230
2231 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV16(pn) ((u16)(pn & 0xffff))
2232 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV32(pn) ((u32)((pn >> 16) & 0xffffffff))
2233
2234 /**
2235 * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter
2236 *
2237 * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order
2238 * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2239 * reverse order than in packet)
2240 * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2241 * reverse order than in packet)
2242 * @aes_gmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2243 * reverse order than in packet)
2244 * @gcmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2245 * reverse order than in packet)
2246 * @hw: data for HW-only (e.g. cipher scheme) keys
2247 */
2248 struct ieee80211_key_seq {
2249 union {
2250 struct {
2251 u32 iv32;
2252 u16 iv16;
2253 } tkip;
2254 struct {
2255 u8 pn[6];
2256 } ccmp;
2257 struct {
2258 u8 pn[6];
2259 } aes_cmac;
2260 struct {
2261 u8 pn[6];
2262 } aes_gmac;
2263 struct {
2264 u8 pn[6];
2265 } gcmp;
2266 struct {
2267 u8 seq[IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN];
2268 u8 seq_len;
2269 } hw;
2270 };
2271 };
2272
2273 /**
2274 * enum set_key_cmd - key command
2275 *
2276 * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2277 * indicates whether a key is being removed or added.
2278 *
2279 * @SET_KEY: a key is set
2280 * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled
2281 */
2282 enum set_key_cmd {
2283 SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY,
2284 };
2285
2286 /**
2287 * enum ieee80211_sta_state - station state
2288 *
2289 * @IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST: station doesn't exist at all,
2290 * this is a special state for add/remove transitions
2291 * @IEEE80211_STA_NONE: station exists without special state
2292 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTH: station is authenticated
2293 * @IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC: station is associated
2294 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
2295 */
2296 enum ieee80211_sta_state {
2297 /* NOTE: These need to be ordered correctly! */
2298 IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST,
2299 IEEE80211_STA_NONE,
2300 IEEE80211_STA_AUTH,
2301 IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC,
2302 IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED,
2303 };
2304
2305 /**
2306 * enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth - station RX bandwidth
2307 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20: station can only receive 20 MHz
2308 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40: station can receive up to 40 MHz
2309 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80: station can receive up to 80 MHz
2310 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160: station can receive up to 160 MHz
2311 * (including 80+80 MHz)
2312 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320: station can receive up to 320 MHz
2313 *
2314 * Implementation note: 20 must be zero to be initialized
2315 * correctly, the values must be sorted.
2316 */
2317 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth {
2318 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20 = 0,
2319 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40,
2320 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80,
2321 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160,
2322 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320,
2323 };
2324
2325 /**
2326 * struct ieee80211_sta_rates - station rate selection table
2327 *
2328 * @rcu_head: RCU head used for freeing the table on update
2329 * @rate: transmit rates/flags to be used by default.
2330 * Overriding entries per-packet is possible by using cb tx control.
2331 */
2332 struct ieee80211_sta_rates {
2333 struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2334 struct {
2335 s8 idx;
2336 u8 count;
2337 u8 count_cts;
2338 u8 count_rts;
2339 u16 flags;
2340 } rate[IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE];
2341 };
2342
2343 /**
2344 * struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
2345 *
2346 * Used to configure txpower for station.
2347 *
2348 * @power: indicates the tx power, in dBm, to be used when sending data frames
2349 * to the STA.
2350 * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
2351 * will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
2352 * %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
2353 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
2354 * per peer TPC.
2355 */
2356 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr {
2357 s16 power;
2358 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
2359 };
2360
2361 /**
2362 * struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates - info that is aggregated from active links
2363 *
2364 * Used for any per-link data that needs to be aggregated and updated in the
2365 * main &struct ieee80211_sta when updated or the active links change.
2366 *
2367 * @max_amsdu_len: indicates the maximal length of an A-MSDU in bytes.
2368 * This field is always valid for packets with a VHT preamble.
2369 * For packets with a HT preamble, additional limits apply:
2370 *
2371 * * If the skb is transmitted as part of a BA agreement, the
2372 * A-MSDU maximal size is min(max_amsdu_len, 4065) bytes.
2373 * * If the skb is not part of a BA agreement, the A-MSDU maximal
2374 * size is min(max_amsdu_len, 7935) bytes.
2375 *
2376 * Both additional HT limits must be enforced by the low level
2377 * driver. This is defined by the spec (IEEE 802.11-2012 section
2378 * 8.3.2.2 NOTE 2).
2379 * @max_rc_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes recommended by rate control.
2380 * @max_tid_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes for this TID
2381 */
2382 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates {
2383 u16 max_amsdu_len;
2384
2385 u16 max_rc_amsdu_len;
2386 u16 max_tid_amsdu_len[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS];
2387 };
2388
2389 /**
2390 * struct ieee80211_link_sta - station Link specific info
2391 * All link specific info for a STA link for a non MLD STA(single)
2392 * or a MLD STA(multiple entries) are stored here.
2393 *
2394 * @sta: reference to owning STA
2395 * @addr: MAC address of the Link STA. For non-MLO STA this is same as the addr
2396 * in ieee80211_sta. For MLO Link STA this addr can be same or different
2397 * from addr in ieee80211_sta (representing MLD STA addr)
2398 * @link_id: the link ID for this link STA (0 for deflink)
2399 * @smps_mode: current SMPS mode (off, static or dynamic)
2400 * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates
2401 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2402 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2403 * @he_cap: HE capabilities of this STA
2404 * @he_6ghz_capa: on 6 GHz, holds the HE 6 GHz band capabilities
2405 * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities of this STA
2406 * @agg: per-link data for multi-link aggregation
2407 * @bandwidth: current bandwidth the station can receive with
2408 * @rx_nss: in HT/VHT, the maximum number of spatial streams the
2409 * station can receive at the moment, changed by operating mode
2410 * notifications and capabilities. The value is only valid after
2411 * the station moves to associated state.
2412 * @txpwr: the station tx power configuration
2413 *
2414 */
2415 struct ieee80211_link_sta {
2416 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2417
2418 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2419 u8 link_id;
2420 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
2421
2422 u32 supp_rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2423 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
2424 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
2425 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
2426 struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
2427 struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap;
2428
2429 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates agg;
2430
2431 u8 rx_nss;
2432 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bandwidth;
2433 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr txpwr;
2434 };
2435
2436 /**
2437 * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry
2438 *
2439 * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly
2440 * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in
2441 * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must
2442 * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly,
2443 * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a
2444 * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it.
2445 * This also represents the MLD STA in case of MLO association
2446 * and holds pointers to various link STA's
2447 *
2448 * @addr: MAC address
2449 * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP
2450 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximal amount of frames in a single AMPDU
2451 * that this station is allowed to transmit to us.
2452 * Can be modified by driver.
2453 * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports QoS/WME (if local devices does,
2454 * otherwise always false)
2455 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
2456 * sizeof(void \*), size is determined in hw information.
2457 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Only valid
2458 * if wme is supported. The bits order is like in
2459 * IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_*.
2460 * @max_sp: max Service Period. Only valid if wme is supported.
2461 * @rates: rate control selection table
2462 * @tdls: indicates whether the STA is a TDLS peer
2463 * @tdls_initiator: indicates the STA is an initiator of the TDLS link. Only
2464 * valid if the STA is a TDLS peer in the first place.
2465 * @mfp: indicates whether the STA uses management frame protection or not.
2466 * @mlo: indicates whether the STA is MLO station.
2467 * @max_amsdu_subframes: indicates the maximal number of MSDUs in a single
2468 * A-MSDU. Taken from the Extended Capabilities element. 0 means
2469 * unlimited.
2470 * @cur: currently valid data as aggregated from the active links
2471 * For non MLO STA it will point to the deflink data. For MLO STA
2472 * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates() must be called to update it.
2473 * @support_p2p_ps: indicates whether the STA supports P2P PS mechanism or not.
2474 * @txq: per-TID data TX queues; note that the last entry (%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS)
2475 * is used for non-data frames
2476 * @deflink: This holds the default link STA information, for non MLO STA all link
2477 * specific STA information is accessed through @deflink or through
2478 * link[0] which points to address of @deflink. For MLO Link STA
2479 * the first added link STA will point to deflink.
2480 * @link: reference to Link Sta entries. For Non MLO STA, except 1st link,
2481 * i.e link[0] all links would be assigned to NULL by default and
2482 * would access link information via @deflink or link[0]. For MLO
2483 * STA, first link STA being added will point its link pointer to
2484 * @deflink address and remaining would be allocated and the address
2485 * would be assigned to link[link_id] where link_id is the id assigned
2486 * by the AP.
2487 * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO
2488 * @spp_amsdu: indicates whether the STA uses SPP A-MSDU or not.
2489 */
2490 struct ieee80211_sta {
2491 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2492 u16 aid;
2493 u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2494 bool wme;
2495 u8 uapsd_queues;
2496 u8 max_sp;
2497 struct ieee80211_sta_rates __rcu *rates;
2498 bool tdls;
2499 bool tdls_initiator;
2500 bool mfp;
2501 bool mlo;
2502 bool spp_amsdu;
2503 u8 max_amsdu_subframes;
2504
2505 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates *cur;
2506
2507 bool support_p2p_ps;
2508
2509 struct ieee80211_txq *txq[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS + 1];
2510
2511 u16 valid_links;
2512 struct ieee80211_link_sta deflink;
2513 struct ieee80211_link_sta __rcu *link[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
2514
2515 /* must be last */
2516 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2517 };
2518
2519 #ifdef CONFIG_LOCKDEP
2520 bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
2521 #else
lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta * pubsta)2522 static inline bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta)
2523 {
2524 return true;
2525 }
2526 #endif
2527
2528 #define link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id) \
2529 rcu_dereference_protected((sta)->link[link_id], \
2530 lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2531
2532 #define link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id) \
2533 rcu_dereference_check((sta)->link[link_id], \
2534 lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2535
2536 #define for_each_sta_active_link(vif, sta, link_sta, link_id) \
2537 for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((sta)->link); link_id++) \
2538 if ((!(vif)->active_links || \
2539 (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) && \
2540 ((link_sta) = link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id)))
2541
2542 /**
2543 * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command
2544 *
2545 * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2546 * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition.
2547 *
2548 * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping
2549 * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up
2550 */
2551 enum sta_notify_cmd {
2552 STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE,
2553 };
2554
2555 /**
2556 * struct ieee80211_tx_control - TX control data
2557 *
2558 * @sta: station table entry, this sta pointer may be NULL and
2559 * it is not allowed to copy the pointer, due to RCU.
2560 */
2561 struct ieee80211_tx_control {
2562 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2563 };
2564
2565 /**
2566 * struct ieee80211_txq - Software intermediate tx queue
2567 *
2568 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2569 * @sta: station table entry, %NULL for per-vif queue
2570 * @tid: the TID for this queue (unused for per-vif queue),
2571 * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS for non-data (if enabled)
2572 * @ac: the AC for this queue
2573 * @drv_priv: driver private area, sized by hw->txq_data_size
2574 *
2575 * The driver can obtain packets from this queue by calling
2576 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue().
2577 */
2578 struct ieee80211_txq {
2579 struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
2580 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2581 u8 tid;
2582 u8 ac;
2583
2584 /* must be last */
2585 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2586 };
2587
2588 /**
2589 * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags
2590 *
2591 * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to
2592 * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning
2593 * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting
2594 * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule,
2595 * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully.
2596 *
2597 * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL:
2598 * The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be
2599 * controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm
2600 * should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace
2601 * will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control
2602 * algorithm.
2603 * Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of
2604 * callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have
2605 * the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config
2606 * @use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot
2607 * timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for
2608 * CCK frames.
2609 *
2610 * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS:
2611 * Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include
2612 * the FCS at the end.
2613 *
2614 * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING:
2615 * Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames
2616 * for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others
2617 * rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used
2618 * to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and
2619 * multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that
2620 * the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc().
2621 *
2622 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC:
2623 * Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We
2624 * expect values between 0 and @max_signal.
2625 * If possible please provide dB or dBm instead.
2626 *
2627 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM:
2628 * Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from
2629 * one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized
2630 * between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set.
2631 *
2632 * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT:
2633 * Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h
2634 * Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC
2635 *
2636 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION:
2637 * Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation.
2638 *
2639 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS:
2640 * Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep).
2641 *
2642 * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK:
2643 * Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies
2644 * stack support for dynamic PS.
2645 *
2646 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS:
2647 * Hardware has support for dynamic PS.
2648 *
2649 * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE:
2650 * Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w).
2651 *
2652 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS:
2653 * Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to
2654 * the stack.
2655 *
2656 * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR:
2657 * The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including
2658 * periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss.
2659 *
2660 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC:
2661 * This device needs to get data from beacon before association (i.e.
2662 * dtim_period).
2663 *
2664 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports
2665 * per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If
2666 * the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not
2667 * to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still
2668 * possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag
2669 * only in that case.
2670 *
2671 * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device
2672 * autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When
2673 * this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected
2674 * stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames.
2675 * Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure
2676 * the PS mode of connected stations.
2677 *
2678 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW: The device handles TX A-MPDU session
2679 * setup strictly in HW. mac80211 should not attempt to do this in
2680 * software.
2681 *
2682 * @IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF: The driver would like to be informed of
2683 * a virtual monitor interface when monitor interfaces are the only
2684 * active interfaces.
2685 *
2686 * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF: The driver would like for no wlanX to
2687 * be created. It is expected user-space will create vifs as
2688 * desired (and thus have them named as desired).
2689 *
2690 * @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL: The driver wants to control which of the
2691 * crypto algorithms can be done in software - so don't automatically
2692 * try to fall back to it if hardware crypto fails, but do so only if
2693 * the driver returns 1. This also forces the driver to advertise its
2694 * supported cipher suites.
2695 *
2696 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT: The driver/hardware supports fast-xmit,
2697 * this currently requires only the ability to calculate the duration
2698 * for frames.
2699 *
2700 * @IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL: The driver wants to control per-interface
2701 * queue mapping in order to use different queues (not just one per AC)
2702 * for different virtual interfaces. See the doc section on HW queue
2703 * control for more details.
2704 *
2705 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE: The driver supports using a rate
2706 * selection table provided by the rate control algorithm.
2707 *
2708 * @IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF: Use the P2P Device address for any
2709 * P2P Interface. This will be honoured even if more than one interface
2710 * is supported.
2711 *
2712 * @IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY: Use sync timing from beacon frames
2713 * only, to allow getting TBTT of a DTIM beacon.
2714 *
2715 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES: Hardware supports mixing HT/CCK rates
2716 * and can cope with CCK rates in an aggregation session (e.g. by not
2717 * using aggregation for such frames.)
2718 *
2719 * @IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA: Support 802.11h based channel-switch (CSA)
2720 * for a single active channel while using channel contexts. When support
2721 * is not enabled the default action is to disconnect when getting the
2722 * CSA frame.
2723 *
2724 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS: The driver will never modify the payload
2725 * or tailroom of TX skbs without copying them first.
2726 *
2727 * @IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS: The HW supports scanning on all bands
2728 * in one command, mac80211 doesn't have to run separate scans per band.
2729 *
2730 * @IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW: The device/driver supports wider bandwidth
2731 * than then BSS bandwidth for a TDLS link on the base channel.
2732 *
2733 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU: The driver supports receiving A-MSDUs
2734 * within A-MPDU.
2735 *
2736 * @IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS: The device/driver provides TX status
2737 * for sent beacons.
2738 *
2739 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR: Hardware (or driver) requires that each
2740 * station has a unique address, i.e. each station entry can be identified
2741 * by just its MAC address; this prevents, for example, the same station
2742 * from connecting to two virtual AP interfaces at the same time.
2743 *
2744 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER: Hardware (or driver) manages the
2745 * reordering buffer internally, guaranteeing mac80211 receives frames in
2746 * order and does not need to manage its own reorder buffer or BA session
2747 * timeout.
2748 *
2749 * @IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS: The device uses RSS and thus requires parallel RX,
2750 * which implies using per-CPU station statistics.
2751 *
2752 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU: Hardware (or driver) supports software aggregated
2753 * A-MSDU frames. Requires software tx queueing and fast-xmit support.
2754 * When not using minstrel/minstrel_ht rate control, the driver must
2755 * limit the maximum A-MSDU size based on the current tx rate by setting
2756 * max_rc_amsdu_len in struct ieee80211_sta.
2757 *
2758 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST: Hardware (or driver) supports sending frag_list
2759 * skbs, needed for zero-copy software A-MSDU.
2760 *
2761 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK: The driver (or firmware) reports low ack event
2762 * by ieee80211_report_low_ack() based on its own algorithm. For such
2763 * drivers, mac80211 packet loss mechanism will not be triggered and driver
2764 * is completely depending on firmware event for station kickout.
2765 *
2766 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG: Hardware does fragmentation by itself.
2767 * The stack will not do fragmentation.
2768 * The callback for @set_frag_threshold should be set as well.
2769 *
2770 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA: Hardware supports buffer STA on
2771 * TDLS links.
2772 *
2773 * @IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP: The driver (or firmware) doesn't
2774 * support QoS NDP for AP probing - that's most likely a driver bug.
2775 *
2776 * @IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ: use the TXQ for bufferable MMPDUs, this of
2777 * course requires the driver to use TXQs to start with.
2778 *
2779 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: (Hardware) rate control supports VHT
2780 * extended NSS BW (dot11VHTExtendedNSSBWCapable). This flag will be set if
2781 * the selected rate control algorithm sets %RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW
2782 * but if the rate control is built-in then it must be set by the driver.
2783 * See also the documentation for that flag.
2784 *
2785 * @IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ: use the extra non-TID per-station TXQ for all
2786 * MMPDUs on station interfaces. This of course requires the driver to use
2787 * TXQs to start with.
2788 *
2789 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN: Driver does not report accurate A-MPDU
2790 * length in tx status information
2791 *
2792 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2793 *
2794 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2795 * only for HE APs. Applies if @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID is set.
2796 *
2797 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT: The card and driver is only
2798 * aggregating MPDUs with the same keyid, allowing mac80211 to keep Tx
2799 * A-MPDU sessions active while rekeying with Extended Key ID.
2800 *
2801 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports tx encapsulation
2802 * offload
2803 *
2804 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports rx decapsulation
2805 * offload
2806 *
2807 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP: Hardware supports concurrent rx
2808 * decapsulation offload and passing raw 802.11 frames for monitor iface.
2809 * If this is supported, the driver must pass both 802.3 frames for real
2810 * usage and 802.11 frames with %RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR set for monitor to
2811 * the stack.
2812 *
2813 * @IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION: HW/driver has support for BSS color
2814 * collision detection and doesn't need it in software.
2815 *
2816 * @IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX: Hardware/driver handles transmitting
2817 * multicast frames on all links, mac80211 should not do that.
2818 *
2819 * @IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING: HW requires disabling puncturing in EHT
2820 * and connecting with a lower bandwidth instead
2821 * @IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING_5GHZ: HW requires disabling puncturing in
2822 * EHT in 5 GHz and connecting with a lower bandwidth instead
2823 *
2824 * @IEEE80211_HW_HANDLES_QUIET_CSA: HW/driver handles quieting for CSA, so
2825 * no need to stop queues. This really should be set by a driver that
2826 * implements MLO, so operation can continue on other links when one
2827 * link is switching.
2828 *
2829 * @NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS: number of hardware flags, used for sizing arrays
2830 */
2831 enum ieee80211_hw_flags {
2832 IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL,
2833 IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS,
2834 IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING,
2835 IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
2836 IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM,
2837 IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC,
2838 IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT,
2839 IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION,
2840 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS,
2841 IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK,
2842 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS,
2843 IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE,
2844 IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF,
2845 IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF,
2846 IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL,
2847 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT,
2848 IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS,
2849 IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR,
2850 IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL,
2851 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK,
2852 IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS,
2853 IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW,
2854 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE,
2855 IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF,
2856 IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY,
2857 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES,
2858 IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA,
2859 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS,
2860 IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS,
2861 IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW,
2862 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU,
2863 IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS,
2864 IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR,
2865 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER,
2866 IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS,
2867 IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU,
2868 IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST,
2869 IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK,
2870 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG,
2871 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA,
2872 IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP,
2873 IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ,
2874 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW,
2875 IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ,
2876 IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN,
2877 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID,
2878 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID,
2879 IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT,
2880 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD,
2881 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD,
2882 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP,
2883 IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION,
2884 IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX,
2885 IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING,
2886 IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING_5GHZ,
2887 IEEE80211_HW_HANDLES_QUIET_CSA,
2888
2889 /* keep last, obviously */
2890 NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS
2891 };
2892
2893 /**
2894 * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state
2895 *
2896 * This structure contains the configuration and hardware
2897 * information for an 802.11 PHY.
2898 *
2899 * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this
2900 * 802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev
2901 * members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV()
2902 * and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported
2903 * bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here.
2904 *
2905 * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use.
2906 *
2907 * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use
2908 * along with this structure.
2909 *
2910 * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags.
2911 *
2912 * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb
2913 * for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.)
2914 *
2915 * @extra_beacon_tailroom: tailroom to reserve in each beacon tx skb.
2916 * Can be used by drivers to add extra IEs.
2917 *
2918 * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used
2919 * only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB
2920 *
2921 * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval
2922 * that HW supports
2923 *
2924 * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for
2925 * data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these
2926 * queues need to have configurable access parameters.
2927 *
2928 * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware.
2929 * If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be
2930 * set before calling ieee80211_register_hw().
2931 *
2932 * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2933 * within &struct ieee80211_vif.
2934 * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2935 * within &struct ieee80211_sta.
2936 * @chanctx_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2937 * within &struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf.
2938 * @txq_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2939 * within @struct ieee80211_txq.
2940 *
2941 * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw
2942 * can handle.
2943 * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages
2944 * the hw can report back.
2945 * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage
2946 *
2947 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of
2948 * sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver
2949 * aggregation.
2950 * This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the
2951 * number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering
2952 * it shouldn't be set.
2953 *
2954 * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an
2955 * aggregate an HT/HE device will transmit. In HT AddBA we'll
2956 * advertise a constant value of 64 as some older APs crash if
2957 * the window size is smaller (an example is LinkSys WRT120N
2958 * with FW v1.0.07 build 002 Jun 18 2012).
2959 * For AddBA to HE capable peers this value will be used.
2960 *
2961 * @max_tx_fragments: maximum number of tx buffers per (A)-MSDU, sum
2962 * of 1 + skb_shinfo(skb)->nr_frags for each skb in the frag_list.
2963 *
2964 * @offchannel_tx_hw_queue: HW queue ID to use for offchannel TX
2965 * (if %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL is set)
2966 *
2967 * @radiotap_mcs_details: lists which MCS information can the HW
2968 * reports, by default it is set to _MCS, _GI and _BW but doesn't
2969 * include _FMT. Use %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_\* values, only
2970 * adding _BW is supported today.
2971 *
2972 * @radiotap_vht_details: lists which VHT MCS information the HW reports,
2973 * the default is _GI | _BANDWIDTH.
2974 * Use the %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_VHT_KNOWN_\* values.
2975 *
2976 * @radiotap_timestamp: Information for the radiotap timestamp field; if the
2977 * @units_pos member is set to a non-negative value then the timestamp
2978 * field will be added and populated from the &struct ieee80211_rx_status
2979 * device_timestamp.
2980 * @radiotap_timestamp.units_pos: Must be set to a combination of a
2981 * IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_UNIT_* and a
2982 * IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_SPOS_* value.
2983 * @radiotap_timestamp.accuracy: If non-negative, fills the accuracy in the
2984 * radiotap field and the accuracy known flag will be set.
2985 *
2986 * @netdev_features: netdev features to be set in each netdev created
2987 * from this HW. Note that not all features are usable with mac80211,
2988 * other features will be rejected during HW registration.
2989 *
2990 * @uapsd_queues: This bitmap is included in (re)association frame to indicate
2991 * for each access category if it is uAPSD trigger-enabled and delivery-
2992 * enabled. Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_* to set this bitmap.
2993 * Each bit corresponds to different AC. Value '1' in specific bit means
2994 * that corresponding AC is both trigger- and delivery-enabled. '0' means
2995 * neither enabled.
2996 *
2997 * @uapsd_max_sp_len: maximum number of total buffered frames the WMM AP may
2998 * deliver to a WMM STA during any Service Period triggered by the WMM STA.
2999 * Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_SP_* for correct values.
3000 *
3001 * @max_nan_de_entries: maximum number of NAN DE functions supported by the
3002 * device.
3003 *
3004 * @tx_sk_pacing_shift: Pacing shift to set on TCP sockets when frames from
3005 * them are encountered. The default should typically not be changed,
3006 * unless the driver has good reasons for needing more buffers.
3007 *
3008 * @weight_multiplier: Driver specific airtime weight multiplier used while
3009 * refilling deficit of each TXQ.
3010 *
3011 * @max_mtu: the max mtu could be set.
3012 *
3013 * @tx_power_levels: a list of power levels supported by the wifi hardware.
3014 * The power levels can be specified either as integer or fractions.
3015 * The power level at idx 0 shall be the maximum positive power level.
3016 *
3017 * @max_txpwr_levels_idx: the maximum valid idx of 'tx_power_levels' list.
3018 */
3019 struct ieee80211_hw {
3020 struct ieee80211_conf conf;
3021 struct wiphy *wiphy;
3022 const char *rate_control_algorithm;
3023 void *priv;
3024 unsigned long flags[BITS_TO_LONGS(NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS)];
3025 unsigned int extra_tx_headroom;
3026 unsigned int extra_beacon_tailroom;
3027 int vif_data_size;
3028 int sta_data_size;
3029 int chanctx_data_size;
3030 int txq_data_size;
3031 u16 queues;
3032 u16 max_listen_interval;
3033 s8 max_signal;
3034 u8 max_rates;
3035 u8 max_report_rates;
3036 u8 max_rate_tries;
3037 u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
3038 u16 max_tx_aggregation_subframes;
3039 u8 max_tx_fragments;
3040 u8 offchannel_tx_hw_queue;
3041 u8 radiotap_mcs_details;
3042 u16 radiotap_vht_details;
3043 struct {
3044 int units_pos;
3045 s16 accuracy;
3046 } radiotap_timestamp;
3047 netdev_features_t netdev_features;
3048 u8 uapsd_queues;
3049 u8 uapsd_max_sp_len;
3050 u8 max_nan_de_entries;
3051 u8 tx_sk_pacing_shift;
3052 u8 weight_multiplier;
3053 u32 max_mtu;
3054 const s8 *tx_power_levels;
3055 u8 max_txpwr_levels_idx;
3056 };
3057
_ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)3058 static inline bool _ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3059 enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
3060 {
3061 return test_bit(flg, hw->flags);
3062 }
3063 #define ieee80211_hw_check(hw, flg) _ieee80211_hw_check(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
3064
_ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)3065 static inline void _ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3066 enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
3067 {
3068 return __set_bit(flg, hw->flags);
3069 }
3070 #define ieee80211_hw_set(hw, flg) _ieee80211_hw_set(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
3071
3072 /**
3073 * struct ieee80211_scan_request - hw scan request
3074 *
3075 * @ies: pointers different parts of IEs (in req.ie)
3076 * @req: cfg80211 request.
3077 */
3078 struct ieee80211_scan_request {
3079 struct ieee80211_scan_ies ies;
3080
3081 /* Keep last */
3082 struct cfg80211_scan_request req;
3083 };
3084
3085 /**
3086 * struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params - TDLS channel switch parameters
3087 *
3088 * @sta: peer this TDLS channel-switch request/response came from
3089 * @chandef: channel referenced in a TDLS channel-switch request
3090 * @action_code: see &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode
3091 * @status: channel-switch response status
3092 * @timestamp: time at which the frame was received
3093 * @switch_time: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
3094 * @switch_timeout: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
3095 * @tmpl_skb: TDLS switch-channel response template
3096 * @ch_sw_tm_ie: offset of the channel-switch timing IE inside @tmpl_skb
3097 */
3098 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params {
3099 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3100 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef;
3101 u8 action_code;
3102 u32 status;
3103 u32 timestamp;
3104 u16 switch_time;
3105 u16 switch_timeout;
3106 struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb;
3107 u32 ch_sw_tm_ie;
3108 };
3109
3110 /**
3111 * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy
3112 *
3113 * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query
3114 *
3115 * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective
3116 * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private
3117 * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should
3118 * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this
3119 * is already used internally by mac80211.
3120 *
3121 * Return: The mac80211 driver hw struct of @wiphy.
3122 */
3123 struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy);
3124
3125 /**
3126 * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware
3127 *
3128 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for
3129 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
3130 */
SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct device * dev)3131 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev)
3132 {
3133 set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev);
3134 }
3135
3136 /**
3137 * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware
3138 *
3139 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for
3140 * @addr: the address to set
3141 */
SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const u8 * addr)3142 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, const u8 *addr)
3143 {
3144 memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN);
3145 }
3146
3147 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c)3148 ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3149 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
3150 {
3151 if (WARN_ON_ONCE(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0))
3152 return NULL;
3153 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx];
3154 }
3155
3156 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c)3157 ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3158 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
3159 {
3160 if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0)
3161 return NULL;
3162 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx];
3163 }
3164
3165 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c,int idx)3166 ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3167 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx)
3168 {
3169 if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0)
3170 return NULL;
3171 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx];
3172 }
3173
3174 /**
3175 * ieee80211_free_txskb - free TX skb
3176 * @hw: the hardware
3177 * @skb: the skb
3178 *
3179 * Free a transmit skb. Use this function when some failure
3180 * to transmit happened and thus status cannot be reported.
3181 */
3182 void ieee80211_free_txskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
3183
3184 /**
3185 * ieee80211_purge_tx_queue - purge TX skb queue
3186 * @hw: the hardware
3187 * @skbs: the skbs
3188 *
3189 * Free a set of transmit skbs. Use this function when device is going to stop
3190 * but some transmit skbs without TX status are still queued.
3191 * This function does not take the list lock and the caller must hold the
3192 * relevant locks to use it.
3193 */
3194 void ieee80211_purge_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3195 struct sk_buff_head *skbs);
3196
3197 /**
3198 * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration
3199 *
3200 * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware
3201 * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations.
3202 *
3203 * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given
3204 * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and
3205 * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL
3206 * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to
3207 * the station information for the peer for individual keys.
3208 * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when
3209 * VLANs are configured for an access point.
3210 *
3211 * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx
3212 * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf
3213 * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function.
3214 *
3215 * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if
3216 * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be
3217 * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the
3218 * hardware key index. You are free to use the full u8 range.
3219 *
3220 * Note that in the case that the @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL flag is
3221 * set, mac80211 will not automatically fall back to software crypto if
3222 * enabling hardware crypto failed. The set_key() call may also return the
3223 * value 1 to permit this specific key/algorithm to be done in software.
3224 *
3225 * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed.
3226 *
3227 * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key
3228 * for it has been uploaded to hardware. The stack will not make any
3229 * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather
3230 * based on the receive flags.
3231 *
3232 * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key
3233 * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key()
3234 * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate
3235 * keys.
3236 *
3237 * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption
3238 * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key
3239 * handler.
3240 * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key.
3241 * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The
3242 * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did
3243 * rekeying); it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is
3244 * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this
3245 * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16.
3246 *
3247 * The set_default_unicast_key() call updates the default WEP key index
3248 * configured to the hardware for WEP encryption type. This is required
3249 * for devices that support offload of data packets (e.g. ARP responses).
3250 *
3251 * Mac80211 drivers should set the @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0 flag
3252 * when they are able to replace in-use PTK keys according to the following
3253 * requirements:
3254 * 1) They do not hand over frames decrypted with the old key to mac80211
3255 once the call to set_key() with command %DISABLE_KEY has been completed,
3256 2) either drop or continue to use the old key for any outgoing frames queued
3257 at the time of the key deletion (including re-transmits),
3258 3) never send out a frame queued prior to the set_key() %SET_KEY command
3259 encrypted with the new key when also needing
3260 @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV and
3261 4) never send out a frame unencrypted when it should be encrypted.
3262 Mac80211 will not queue any new frames for a deleted key to the driver.
3263 */
3264
3265 /**
3266 * DOC: Powersave support
3267 *
3268 * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations.
3269 *
3270 * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself;
3271 * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware
3272 * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode
3273 * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status.
3274 * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary,
3275 * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required
3276 * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when
3277 * it finds traffic directed to it.
3278 *
3279 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in
3280 * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused
3281 * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking
3282 * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it
3283 * back to sleep at appropriate times.
3284 *
3285 * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the
3286 * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be
3287 * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame.
3288 *
3289 * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also
3290 * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported
3291 * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and
3292 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still
3293 * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle
3294 * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that
3295 * as best as it can; mac80211 is too slow to do that.
3296 *
3297 * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the
3298 * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a
3299 * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to
3300 * the next wakeup. It's a compromise of getting good enough latency when
3301 * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle
3302 * periods.
3303 *
3304 * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling
3305 * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS
3306 * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally,
3307 * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the
3308 * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support
3309 * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the
3310 * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value
3311 * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable
3312 * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS
3313 * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave.
3314 *
3315 * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling
3316 * %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the
3317 * uapsd parameter in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS
3318 * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To
3319 * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames
3320 * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled.
3321 *
3322 * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with
3323 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK.
3324 */
3325
3326 /**
3327 * DOC: Beacon filter support
3328 *
3329 * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups
3330 * which will reduce system power consumption. It usually works so that
3331 * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly
3332 * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the
3333 * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That
3334 * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information
3335 * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed.
3336 *
3337 * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER
3338 * interface capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support
3339 * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When
3340 * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the
3341 * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss().
3342 *
3343 * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the
3344 * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call
3345 * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled
3346 * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future.
3347 *
3348 * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing
3349 * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211
3350 * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense
3351 * that we want to see changes in them. This will include
3352 *
3353 * - a list of information element IDs
3354 * - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element
3355 *
3356 * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the
3357 * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense
3358 * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device
3359 * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all
3360 * vendor information elements.
3361 *
3362 * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information
3363 * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon.
3364 *
3365 * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead. Just make sure nothing
3366 * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing
3367 * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and
3368 * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136,
3369 * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility
3370 * it could also include some currently unused IDs.
3371 *
3372 *
3373 * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the
3374 * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming
3375 * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of
3376 * the received data packets). This can consist of notifying the host when
3377 * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above
3378 * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be
3379 * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement
3380 * them as the roaming algorithm requires.
3381 *
3382 * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to
3383 * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the
3384 * signal strength threshold checking.
3385 */
3386
3387 /**
3388 * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save
3389 *
3390 * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve
3391 * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism
3392 * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009)
3393 * "11.2.3 SM power save".
3394 *
3395 * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames
3396 * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct
3397 * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the
3398 * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware
3399 * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by
3400 * hardware flags.
3401 *
3402 * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211
3403 * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS
3404 * turned off otherwise.
3405 *
3406 * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate
3407 * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config()
3408 * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to
3409 * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP.
3410 */
3411
3412 /**
3413 * DOC: Frame filtering
3414 *
3415 * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper
3416 * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when
3417 * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption,
3418 * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is
3419 * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible.
3420 *
3421 * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell
3422 * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be
3423 * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out.
3424 *
3425 * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast()
3426 * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list
3427 * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces.
3428 * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to
3429 * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the
3430 * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and
3431 * @total_flags with the new flag states.
3432 *
3433 * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will
3434 * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count
3435 * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted
3436 * or dropped.
3437 *
3438 * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared.
3439 * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_
3440 * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore
3441 * the flag, but not clear it.
3442 * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the
3443 * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type
3444 * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it).
3445 * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware
3446 * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes
3447 * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them,
3448 * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag.
3449 * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well.
3450 */
3451
3452 /**
3453 * DOC: AP support for powersaving clients
3454 *
3455 * In order to implement AP and P2P GO modes, mac80211 has support for
3456 * client powersaving, both "legacy" PS (PS-Poll/null data) and uAPSD.
3457 * There currently is no support for sAPSD.
3458 *
3459 * There is one assumption that mac80211 makes, namely that a client
3460 * will not poll with PS-Poll and trigger with uAPSD at the same time.
3461 * Both are supported, and both can be used by the same client, but
3462 * they can't be used concurrently by the same client. This simplifies
3463 * the driver code.
3464 *
3465 * The first thing to keep in mind is that there is a flag for complete
3466 * driver implementation: %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS. If this flag is set,
3467 * mac80211 expects the driver to handle most of the state machine for
3468 * powersaving clients and will ignore the PM bit in incoming frames.
3469 * Drivers then use ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() to inform mac80211 of
3470 * stations' powersave transitions. In this mode, mac80211 also doesn't
3471 * handle PS-Poll/uAPSD.
3472 *
3473 * In the mode without %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, mac80211 will check the
3474 * PM bit in incoming frames for client powersave transitions. When a
3475 * station goes to sleep, we will stop transmitting to it. There is,
3476 * however, a race condition: a station might go to sleep while there is
3477 * data buffered on hardware queues. If the device has support for this
3478 * it will reject frames, and the driver should give the frames back to
3479 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED flag set which will
3480 * cause mac80211 to retry the frame when the station wakes up. The
3481 * driver is also notified of powersave transitions by calling its
3482 * @sta_notify callback.
3483 *
3484 * When the station is asleep, it has three choices: it can wake up,
3485 * it can PS-Poll, or it can possibly start a uAPSD service period.
3486 * Waking up is implemented by simply transmitting all buffered (and
3487 * filtered) frames to the station. This is the easiest case. When
3488 * the station sends a PS-Poll or a uAPSD trigger frame, mac80211
3489 * will inform the driver of this with the @allow_buffered_frames
3490 * callback; this callback is optional. mac80211 will then transmit
3491 * the frames as usual and set the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER
3492 * on each frame. The last frame in the service period (or the only
3493 * response to a PS-Poll) also has %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set to
3494 * indicate that it ends the service period; as this frame must have
3495 * TX status report it also sets %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS.
3496 * When TX status is reported for this frame, the service period is
3497 * marked has having ended and a new one can be started by the peer.
3498 *
3499 * Additionally, non-bufferable MMPDUs can also be transmitted by
3500 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER set in them.
3501 *
3502 * Another race condition can happen on some devices like iwlwifi
3503 * when there are frames queued for the station and it wakes up
3504 * or polls; the frames that are already queued could end up being
3505 * transmitted first instead, causing reordering and/or wrong
3506 * processing of the EOSP. The cause is that allowing frames to be
3507 * transmitted to a certain station is out-of-band communication to
3508 * the device. To allow this problem to be solved, the driver can
3509 * call ieee80211_sta_block_awake() if frames are buffered when it
3510 * is notified that the station went to sleep. When all these frames
3511 * have been filtered (see above), it must call the function again
3512 * to indicate that the station is no longer blocked.
3513 *
3514 * If the driver buffers frames in the driver for aggregation in any
3515 * way, it must use the ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() call when it is
3516 * notified of the station going to sleep to inform mac80211 of any
3517 * TIDs that have frames buffered. Note that when a station wakes up
3518 * this information is reset (hence the requirement to call it when
3519 * informed of the station going to sleep). Then, when a service
3520 * period starts for any reason, @release_buffered_frames is called
3521 * with the number of frames to be released and which TIDs they are
3522 * to come from. In this case, the driver is responsible for setting
3523 * the EOSP (for uAPSD) and MORE_DATA bits in the released frames.
3524 * To help the @more_data parameter is passed to tell the driver if
3525 * there is more data on other TIDs -- the TIDs to release frames
3526 * from are ignored since mac80211 doesn't know how many frames the
3527 * buffers for those TIDs contain.
3528 *
3529 * If the driver also implement GO mode, where absence periods may
3530 * shorten service periods (or abort PS-Poll responses), it must
3531 * filter those response frames except in the case of frames that
3532 * are buffered in the driver -- those must remain buffered to avoid
3533 * reordering. Because it is possible that no frames are released
3534 * in this case, the driver must call ieee80211_sta_eosp()
3535 * to indicate to mac80211 that the service period ended anyway.
3536 *
3537 * Finally, if frames from multiple TIDs are released from mac80211
3538 * but the driver might reorder them, it must clear & set the flags
3539 * appropriately (only the last frame may have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
3540 * and also take care of the EOSP and MORE_DATA bits in the frame.
3541 * The driver may also use ieee80211_sta_eosp() in this case.
3542 *
3543 * Note that if the driver ever buffers frames other than QoS-data
3544 * frames, it must take care to never send a non-QoS-data frame as
3545 * the last frame in a service period, adding a QoS-nulldata frame
3546 * after a non-QoS-data frame if needed.
3547 */
3548
3549 /**
3550 * DOC: HW queue control
3551 *
3552 * Before HW queue control was introduced, mac80211 only had a single static
3553 * assignment of per-interface AC software queues to hardware queues. This
3554 * was problematic for a few reasons:
3555 * 1) off-channel transmissions might get stuck behind other frames
3556 * 2) multiple virtual interfaces couldn't be handled correctly
3557 * 3) after-DTIM frames could get stuck behind other frames
3558 *
3559 * To solve this, hardware typically uses multiple different queues for all
3560 * the different usages, and this needs to be propagated into mac80211 so it
3561 * won't have the same problem with the software queues.
3562 *
3563 * Therefore, mac80211 now offers the %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL capability
3564 * flag that tells it that the driver implements its own queue control. To do
3565 * so, the driver will set up the various queues in each &struct ieee80211_vif
3566 * and the offchannel queue in &struct ieee80211_hw. In response, mac80211 will
3567 * use those queue IDs in the hw_queue field of &struct ieee80211_tx_info and
3568 * if necessary will queue the frame on the right software queue that mirrors
3569 * the hardware queue.
3570 * Additionally, the driver has to then use these HW queue IDs for the queue
3571 * management functions (ieee80211_stop_queue() et al.)
3572 *
3573 * The driver is free to set up the queue mappings as needed; multiple virtual
3574 * interfaces may map to the same hardware queues if needed. The setup has to
3575 * happen during add_interface or change_interface callbacks. For example, a
3576 * driver supporting station+station and station+AP modes might decide to have
3577 * 10 hardware queues to handle different scenarios:
3578 *
3579 * 4 AC HW queues for 1st vif: 0, 1, 2, 3
3580 * 4 AC HW queues for 2nd vif: 4, 5, 6, 7
3581 * after-DTIM queue for AP: 8
3582 * off-channel queue: 9
3583 *
3584 * It would then set up the hardware like this:
3585 * hw.offchannel_tx_hw_queue = 9
3586 *
3587 * and the first virtual interface that is added as follows:
3588 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VO] = 0
3589 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VI] = 1
3590 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BE] = 2
3591 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BK] = 3
3592 * vif.cab_queue = 8 // if AP mode, otherwise %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3593 * and the second virtual interface with 4-7.
3594 *
3595 * If queue 6 gets full, for example, mac80211 would only stop the second
3596 * virtual interface's BE queue since virtual interface queues are per AC.
3597 *
3598 * Note that the vif.cab_queue value should be set to %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3599 * whenever the queue is not used (i.e. the interface is not in AP mode) if the
3600 * queue could potentially be shared since mac80211 will look at cab_queue when
3601 * a queue is stopped/woken even if the interface is not in AP mode.
3602 */
3603
3604 /**
3605 * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags
3606 *
3607 * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be
3608 * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the
3609 * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested,
3610 * but this has negative impact on power consumption.
3611 *
3612 * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested
3613 * by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by
3614 * multicast address.
3615 *
3616 * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the
3617 * %RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them)
3618 *
3619 * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set
3620 * the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them
3621 *
3622 * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate
3623 * to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses
3624 * by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing
3625 * mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should
3626 * honour this flag if possible.
3627 *
3628 * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll) addressed to this
3629 * station
3630 *
3631 * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes
3632 *
3633 * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames
3634 *
3635 * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames
3636 *
3637 * @FIF_MCAST_ACTION: pass multicast Action frames
3638 */
3639 enum ieee80211_filter_flags {
3640 FIF_ALLMULTI = 1<<1,
3641 FIF_FCSFAIL = 1<<2,
3642 FIF_PLCPFAIL = 1<<3,
3643 FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC = 1<<4,
3644 FIF_CONTROL = 1<<5,
3645 FIF_OTHER_BSS = 1<<6,
3646 FIF_PSPOLL = 1<<7,
3647 FIF_PROBE_REQ = 1<<8,
3648 FIF_MCAST_ACTION = 1<<9,
3649 };
3650
3651 /**
3652 * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions
3653 *
3654 * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in
3655 * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed.
3656 *
3657 * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation
3658 * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by
3659 * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer
3660 * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away!
3661 *
3662 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start RX aggregation
3663 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop RX aggregation
3664 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start TX aggregation, the driver must either
3665 * call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() or
3666 * call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() with status
3667 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA to delay addba after
3668 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe is called, or just return the special
3669 * status %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE.
3670 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational
3671 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT: stop TX aggregation but continue transmitting
3672 * queued packets, now unaggregated. After all packets are transmitted the
3673 * driver has to call ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe().
3674 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH: stop TX aggregation and flush all packets,
3675 * called when the station is removed. There's no need or reason to call
3676 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() in this case as mac80211 assumes the
3677 * session is gone and removes the station.
3678 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT: called when TX aggregation is stopped
3679 * but the driver hasn't called ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() yet and
3680 * now the connection is dropped and the station will be removed. Drivers
3681 * should clean up and drop remaining packets when this is called.
3682 */
3683 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action {
3684 IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START,
3685 IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP,
3686 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START,
3687 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT,
3688 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH,
3689 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT,
3690 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL,
3691 };
3692
3693 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE 1
3694 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA 2
3695
3696 /**
3697 * struct ieee80211_ampdu_params - AMPDU action parameters
3698 *
3699 * @action: the ampdu action, value from %ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
3700 * @sta: peer of this AMPDU session
3701 * @tid: tid of the BA session
3702 * @ssn: start sequence number of the session. TX/RX_STOP can pass 0. When
3703 * action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START the driver passes back the
3704 * actual ssn value used to start the session and writes the value here.
3705 * @buf_size: reorder buffer size (number of subframes). Valid only when the
3706 * action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START or
3707 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3708 * @amsdu: indicates the peer's ability to receive A-MSDU within A-MPDU.
3709 * valid when the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3710 * @timeout: BA session timeout. Valid only when the action is set to
3711 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START
3712 */
3713 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params {
3714 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action;
3715 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3716 u16 tid;
3717 u16 ssn;
3718 u16 buf_size;
3719 bool amsdu;
3720 u16 timeout;
3721 };
3722
3723 /**
3724 * enum ieee80211_frame_release_type - frame release reason
3725 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL: frame released for PS-Poll
3726 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD: frame(s) released due to
3727 * frame received on trigger-enabled AC
3728 */
3729 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type {
3730 IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL,
3731 IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD,
3732 };
3733
3734 /**
3735 * enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed - flags to indicate what changed
3736 *
3737 * @IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED: The bandwidth that can be used to transmit
3738 * to this station changed. The actual bandwidth is in the station
3739 * information -- for HT20/40 the IEEE80211_HT_CAP_SUP_WIDTH_20_40
3740 * flag changes, for HT and VHT the bandwidth field changes.
3741 * @IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED: The SMPS state of the station changed.
3742 * @IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED: The supported rate set of this peer
3743 * changed (in IBSS mode) due to discovering more information about
3744 * the peer.
3745 * @IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED: N_SS (number of spatial streams) was changed
3746 * by the peer
3747 */
3748 enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed {
3749 IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED = BIT(0),
3750 IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED = BIT(1),
3751 IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED = BIT(2),
3752 IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED = BIT(3),
3753 };
3754
3755 /**
3756 * enum ieee80211_roc_type - remain on channel type
3757 *
3758 * With the support for multi channel contexts and multi channel operations,
3759 * remain on channel operations might be limited/deferred/aborted by other
3760 * flows/operations which have higher priority (and vice versa).
3761 * Specifying the ROC type can be used by devices to prioritize the ROC
3762 * operations compared to other operations/flows.
3763 *
3764 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL: There are no special requirements for this ROC.
3765 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX: The remain on channel request is required
3766 * for sending management frames offchannel.
3767 */
3768 enum ieee80211_roc_type {
3769 IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL = 0,
3770 IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX,
3771 };
3772
3773 /**
3774 * enum ieee80211_reconfig_type - reconfig type
3775 *
3776 * This enum is used by the reconfig_complete() callback to indicate what
3777 * reconfiguration type was completed.
3778 *
3779 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART: hw restart type
3780 * (also due to resume() callback returning 1)
3781 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND: suspend type (regardless
3782 * of wowlan configuration)
3783 */
3784 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type {
3785 IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART,
3786 IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND,
3787 };
3788
3789 /**
3790 * struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info - prepare TX information
3791 * @duration: if non-zero, hint about the required duration,
3792 * only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method.
3793 * @subtype: frame subtype (auth, (re)assoc, deauth, disassoc)
3794 * @success: whether the frame exchange was successful, only
3795 * used with the mgd_complete_tx() method, and then only
3796 * valid for auth and (re)assoc.
3797 * @was_assoc: set if this call is due to deauth/disassoc
3798 * while just having been associated
3799 * @link_id: the link id on which the frame will be TX'ed.
3800 * Only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method.
3801 */
3802 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info {
3803 u16 duration;
3804 u16 subtype;
3805 u8 success:1, was_assoc:1;
3806 int link_id;
3807 };
3808
3809 /**
3810 * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver
3811 *
3812 * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may
3813 * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure
3814 * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame.
3815 *
3816 * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame.
3817 * skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header.
3818 * The low-level driver should send the frame out based on
3819 * configuration in the TX control data. This handler should,
3820 * preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately.
3821 * Must be atomic.
3822 *
3823 * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware
3824 * is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on
3825 * frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.)
3826 * Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace,
3827 * or zero.
3828 * When the device is started it should not have a MAC address
3829 * to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device
3830 * is added.
3831 * Must be implemented and can sleep.
3832 *
3833 * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware
3834 * is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least
3835 * it must turn off frame reception.)
3836 * May be called right after add_interface if that rejects
3837 * an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue
3838 * you should ensure to cancel it on this callback.
3839 * Must be implemented and can sleep.
3840 *
3841 * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and
3842 * stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then
3843 * ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is
3844 * configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and
3845 * reconfigured at resume time.
3846 * The driver may also impose special conditions under which it
3847 * wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only
3848 * supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it
3849 * must return 1 from this function.
3850 *
3851 * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is
3852 * now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully
3853 * functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is
3854 * to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211
3855 * will also go through the regular complete restart on resume.
3856 *
3857 * @set_wakeup: Enable or disable wakeup when WoWLAN configuration is
3858 * modified. The reason is that device_set_wakeup_enable() is
3859 * supposed to be called when the configuration changes, not only
3860 * in suspend().
3861 *
3862 * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is
3863 * enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start
3864 * and @stop must be implemented.
3865 * The driver should perform any initialization it needs before
3866 * the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the
3867 * interface is given in the conf parameter.
3868 * The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a
3869 * negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.)
3870 * Must be implemented and can sleep.
3871 *
3872 * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback
3873 * is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be
3874 * switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep.
3875 * Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be
3876 * found by the interface iteration callbacks.
3877 *
3878 * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down.
3879 * The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface
3880 * and no monitor interfaces are present.
3881 * When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware
3882 * must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets,
3883 * the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the
3884 * MAC address of the device going away.
3885 * Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep.
3886 *
3887 * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this
3888 * function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel.
3889 * This function should never fail but returns a negative error code
3890 * if it does. The callback can sleep.
3891 *
3892 * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS
3893 * parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low
3894 * level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters).
3895 * This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless
3896 * for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which
3897 * of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback
3898 * can sleep.
3899 * Note: this callback is called if @vif_cfg_changed or @link_info_changed
3900 * are not implemented.
3901 *
3902 * @vif_cfg_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to interface
3903 * (MLD) parameters from &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg that vary during the
3904 * lifetime of the interface (e.g. assoc status, IP addresses, etc.)
3905 * The @changed parameter indicates which value changed.
3906 * The callback can sleep.
3907 *
3908 * @link_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to link
3909 * parameters from &struct ieee80211_bss_conf that are related to an
3910 * individual link. e.g. legacy/HT/VHT/... rate information.
3911 * The @changed parameter indicates which value changed, and the @link_id
3912 * parameter indicates the link ID. Note that the @link_id will be 0 for
3913 * non-MLO connections.
3914 * The callback can sleep.
3915 *
3916 * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration.
3917 * This callback is optional, and its return value is passed
3918 * to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic.
3919 *
3920 * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter.
3921 * See the section "Frame filtering" for more information.
3922 * This callback must be implemented and can sleep.
3923 *
3924 * @config_iface_filter: Configure the interface's RX filter.
3925 * This callback is optional and is used to configure which frames
3926 * should be passed to mac80211. The filter_flags is the combination
3927 * of FIF_* flags. The changed_flags is a bit mask that indicates
3928 * which flags are changed.
3929 * This callback can sleep.
3930 *
3931 * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit
3932 * must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic.
3933 *
3934 * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3935 * This callback is only called between add_interface and
3936 * remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface
3937 * is enabled.
3938 * Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added.
3939 * The callback can sleep.
3940 *
3941 * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3942 * This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers
3943 * which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY.
3944 * The callback must be atomic.
3945 *
3946 * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the
3947 * host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data
3948 * necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter.
3949 * After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify
3950 * userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify().
3951 *
3952 * @set_default_unicast_key: Set the default (unicast) key index, useful for
3953 * WEP when the device sends data packets autonomously, e.g. for ARP
3954 * offloading. The index can be 0-3, or -1 for unsetting it.
3955 *
3956 * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start
3957 * the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel
3958 * configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's
3959 * registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure
3960 * that power save is disabled.
3961 * The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the
3962 * entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these
3963 * at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the
3964 * (extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable).
3965 * When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called;
3966 * note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to
3967 * any error unless this callback returned a negative error code.
3968 * This callback is also allowed to return the special return value 1,
3969 * this indicates that hardware scan isn't desirable right now and a
3970 * software scan should be done instead. A driver wishing to use this
3971 * capability must ensure its (hardware) scan capabilities aren't
3972 * advertised as more capable than mac80211's software scan is.
3973 * The callback can sleep.
3974 *
3975 * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan.
3976 * The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible),
3977 * but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call
3978 * ieee80211_scan_completed().
3979 * This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new
3980 * scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended.
3981 * The callback can sleep.
3982 *
3983 * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at
3984 * specific intervals. The driver must call the
3985 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results.
3986 * This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called.
3987 *
3988 * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan.
3989 * In this case, ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped() must not be called.
3990 *
3991 * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan
3992 * is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification.
3993 * The mac_addr parameter allows supporting NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR,
3994 * the driver may set the NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR flag if it
3995 * can use this parameter. The callback can sleep.
3996 *
3997 * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a
3998 * software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need
3999 * this notification.
4000 * The callback can sleep.
4001 *
4002 * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics.
4003 * Returns zero if statistics are available.
4004 * The callback can sleep.
4005 *
4006 * @get_key_seq: If your device implements encryption in hardware and does
4007 * IV/PN assignment then this callback should be provided to read the
4008 * IV/PN for the given key from hardware.
4009 * The callback must be atomic.
4010 *
4011 * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this
4012 * if the device does fragmentation by itself. Note that to prevent the
4013 * stack from doing fragmentation IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG
4014 * should be set as well.
4015 * The callback can sleep.
4016 *
4017 * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it)
4018 * The callback can sleep.
4019 *
4020 * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station,
4021 * AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep.
4022 *
4023 * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated
4024 * station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. Note that after the callback
4025 * returns it isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected;
4026 * no RCU grace period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing
4027 * the station. See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
4028 * This callback can sleep.
4029 *
4030 * @vif_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add a debugfs vif
4031 * directory with its files. This callback should be within a
4032 * CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep.
4033 *
4034 * @link_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
4035 * when a link is added to a mac80211 vif. This callback should be within
4036 * a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep.
4037 * For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the default bss_conf
4038 * with the vif's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
4039 *
4040 * @sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
4041 * when a station is added to mac80211's station list. This callback
4042 * should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
4043 * callback can sleep.
4044 *
4045 * @link_sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
4046 * when a link is added to a mac80211 station. This callback
4047 * should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
4048 * callback can sleep.
4049 * For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the deflink with the
4050 * station's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
4051 *
4052 * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an
4053 * associated station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating
4054 * in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag
4055 * %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic.
4056 *
4057 * @sta_set_txpwr: Configure the station tx power. This callback set the tx
4058 * power for the station.
4059 * This callback can sleep.
4060 *
4061 * @sta_state: Notifies low level driver about state transition of a
4062 * station (which can be the AP, a client, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc.)
4063 * This callback is mutually exclusive with @sta_add/@sta_remove.
4064 * It must not fail for down transitions but may fail for transitions
4065 * up the list of states. Also note that after the callback returns it
4066 * isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected - no RCU grace
4067 * period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing the station.
4068 * See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
4069 * The callback can sleep.
4070 *
4071 * @sta_pre_rcu_remove: Notify driver about station removal before RCU
4072 * synchronisation. This is useful if a driver needs to have station
4073 * pointers protected using RCU, it can then use this call to clear
4074 * the pointers instead of waiting for an RCU grace period to elapse
4075 * in @sta_state.
4076 * The callback can sleep.
4077 *
4078 * @sta_rc_update: Notifies the driver of changes to the bitrates that can be
4079 * used to transmit to the station. The changes are advertised with bits
4080 * from &enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed and the values are reflected
4081 * in the station data. This callback should only be used when the driver
4082 * uses hardware rate control (%IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL) since
4083 * otherwise the rate control algorithm is notified directly.
4084 * Must be atomic.
4085 * @sta_rate_tbl_update: Notifies the driver that the rate table changed. This
4086 * is only used if the configured rate control algorithm actually uses
4087 * the new rate table API, and is therefore optional. Must be atomic.
4088 *
4089 * @sta_statistics: Get statistics for this station. For example with beacon
4090 * filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be accurate, so
4091 * let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can fill most of
4092 * the values (indicating which by setting the filled bitmap), but not
4093 * all of them make sense - see the source for which ones are possible.
4094 * Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211.
4095 * The callback can sleep.
4096 *
4097 * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max),
4098 * bursting) for a hardware TX queue.
4099 * Returns a negative error code on failure.
4100 * The callback can sleep.
4101 *
4102 * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently,
4103 * this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a
4104 * required function.
4105 * The callback can sleep.
4106 *
4107 * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware.
4108 * Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a
4109 * required function.
4110 * The callback can sleep.
4111 *
4112 * @offset_tsf: Offset the TSF timer by the specified value in the
4113 * firmware/hardware. Preferred to set_tsf as it avoids delay between
4114 * calling set_tsf() and hardware getting programmed, which will show up
4115 * as TSF delay. Is not a required function.
4116 * The callback can sleep.
4117 *
4118 * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize
4119 * with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This
4120 * function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of
4121 * TSF synchronization.
4122 * The callback can sleep.
4123 *
4124 * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us.
4125 * This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is
4126 * used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests.
4127 * Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon.
4128 * The callback can sleep.
4129 *
4130 * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information
4131 *
4132 * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also
4133 * need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration,
4134 * and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback.
4135 * The callback can sleep.
4136 *
4137 * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified
4138 * in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout
4139 * accordingly; coverage class equals to -1 to enable ACK timeout
4140 * estimation algorithm (dynack). To disable dynack set valid value for
4141 * coverage class. This callback is not required and may sleep.
4142 *
4143 * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command. The passed @vif may
4144 * be %NULL. The callback can sleep.
4145 * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep.
4146 *
4147 * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure
4148 * that the hardware queues are empty. The @queues parameter is a bitmap
4149 * of queues to flush, which is useful if different virtual interfaces
4150 * use different hardware queues; it may also indicate all queues.
4151 * If the parameter @drop is set to %true, pending frames may be dropped.
4152 * Note that vif can be NULL.
4153 * The callback can sleep.
4154 *
4155 * @flush_sta: Flush or drop all pending frames from the hardware queue(s) for
4156 * the given station, as it's about to be removed.
4157 * The callback can sleep.
4158 *
4159 * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel
4160 * switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this
4161 * callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate
4162 * completion of the channel switch.
4163 *
4164 * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
4165 * Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
4166 * reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
4167 * (also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
4168 *
4169 * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
4170 *
4171 * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must
4172 * call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note
4173 * that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw
4174 * offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted
4175 * normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the
4176 * duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call
4177 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired().
4178 * Note that this callback may be called while the device is in IDLE and
4179 * must be accepted in this case.
4180 * This callback may sleep.
4181 * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is
4182 * aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep.
4183 *
4184 * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes.
4185 *
4186 * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes.
4187 *
4188 * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware
4189 * queues before entering power save.
4190 *
4191 * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection
4192 * when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled.
4193 * The callback can sleep.
4194 * @event_callback: Notify driver about any event in mac80211. See
4195 * &enum ieee80211_event_type for the different types.
4196 * The callback must be atomic.
4197 *
4198 * @release_buffered_frames: Release buffered frames according to the given
4199 * parameters. In the case where the driver buffers some frames for
4200 * sleeping stations mac80211 will use this callback to tell the driver
4201 * to release some frames, either for PS-poll or uAPSD.
4202 * Note that if the @more_data parameter is %false the driver must check
4203 * if there are more frames on the given TIDs, and if there are more than
4204 * the frames being released then it must still set the more-data bit in
4205 * the frame. If the @more_data parameter is %true, then of course the
4206 * more-data bit must always be set.
4207 * The @tids parameter tells the driver which TIDs to release frames
4208 * from, for PS-poll it will always have only a single bit set.
4209 * In the case this is used for a PS-poll initiated release, the
4210 * @num_frames parameter will always be 1 so code can be shared. In
4211 * this case the driver must also set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4212 * on the TX status (and must report TX status) so that the PS-poll
4213 * period is properly ended. This is used to avoid sending multiple
4214 * responses for a retried PS-poll frame.
4215 * In the case this is used for uAPSD, the @num_frames parameter may be
4216 * bigger than one, but the driver may send fewer frames (it must send
4217 * at least one, however). In this case it is also responsible for
4218 * setting the EOSP flag in the QoS header of the frames. Also, when the
4219 * service period ends, the driver must set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP
4220 * on the last frame in the SP. Alternatively, it may call the function
4221 * ieee80211_sta_eosp() to inform mac80211 of the end of the SP.
4222 * This callback must be atomic.
4223 * @allow_buffered_frames: Prepare device to allow the given number of frames
4224 * to go out to the given station. The frames will be sent by mac80211
4225 * via the usual TX path after this call. The TX information for frames
4226 * released will also have the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER flag set
4227 * and the last one will also have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set. In case
4228 * frames from multiple TIDs are released and the driver might reorder
4229 * them between the TIDs, it must set the %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4230 * on the last frame and clear it on all others and also handle the EOSP
4231 * bit in the QoS header correctly. Alternatively, it can also call the
4232 * ieee80211_sta_eosp() function.
4233 * The @tids parameter is a bitmap and tells the driver which TIDs the
4234 * frames will be on; it will at most have two bits set.
4235 * This callback must be atomic.
4236 *
4237 * @get_et_sset_count: Ethtool API to get string-set count.
4238 * Note that the wiphy mutex is not held for this callback since it's
4239 * expected to return a static value.
4240 *
4241 * @get_et_stats: Ethtool API to get a set of u64 stats.
4242 *
4243 * @get_et_strings: Ethtool API to get a set of strings to describe stats
4244 * and perhaps other supported types of ethtool data-sets.
4245 * Note that the wiphy mutex is not held for this callback since it's
4246 * expected to return a static value.
4247 *
4248 * @mgd_prepare_tx: Prepare for transmitting a management frame for association
4249 * before associated. In multi-channel scenarios, a virtual interface is
4250 * bound to a channel before it is associated, but as it isn't associated
4251 * yet it need not necessarily be given airtime, in particular since any
4252 * transmission to a P2P GO needs to be synchronized against the GO's
4253 * powersave state. mac80211 will call this function before transmitting a
4254 * management frame prior to transmitting that frame to allow the driver
4255 * to give it channel time for the transmission, to get a response and be
4256 * able to synchronize with the GO.
4257 * The callback will be called before each transmission and upon return
4258 * mac80211 will transmit the frame right away.
4259 * Additional information is passed in the &struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info
4260 * data. If duration there is greater than zero, mac80211 hints to the
4261 * driver the duration for which the operation is requested.
4262 * The callback is optional and can (should!) sleep.
4263 * @mgd_complete_tx: Notify the driver that the response frame for a previously
4264 * transmitted frame announced with @mgd_prepare_tx was received, the data
4265 * is filled similarly to @mgd_prepare_tx though the duration is not used.
4266 *
4267 * @mgd_protect_tdls_discover: Protect a TDLS discovery session. After sending
4268 * a TDLS discovery-request, we expect a reply to arrive on the AP's
4269 * channel. We must stay on the channel (no PSM, scan, etc.), since a TDLS
4270 * setup-response is a direct packet not buffered by the AP.
4271 * mac80211 will call this function just before the transmission of a TDLS
4272 * discovery-request. The recommended period of protection is at least
4273 * 2 * (DTIM period).
4274 * The callback is optional and can sleep.
4275 *
4276 * @add_chanctx: Notifies device driver about new channel context creation.
4277 * This callback may sleep.
4278 * @remove_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context destruction.
4279 * This callback may sleep.
4280 * @change_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context changes that
4281 * may happen when combining different virtual interfaces on the same
4282 * channel context with different settings
4283 * This callback may sleep.
4284 * @assign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being bound
4285 * to vif. Possible use is for hw queue remapping.
4286 * This callback may sleep.
4287 * @unassign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being
4288 * unbound from vif.
4289 * This callback may sleep.
4290 * @switch_vif_chanctx: switch a number of vifs from one chanctx to
4291 * another, as specified in the list of
4292 * @ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch passed to the driver, according
4293 * to the mode defined in &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode.
4294 * This callback may sleep.
4295 *
4296 * @start_ap: Start operation on the AP interface, this is called after all the
4297 * information in bss_conf is set and beacon can be retrieved. A channel
4298 * context is bound before this is called. Note that if the driver uses
4299 * software scan or ROC, this (and @stop_ap) isn't called when the AP is
4300 * just "paused" for scanning/ROC, which is indicated by the beacon being
4301 * disabled/enabled via @bss_info_changed.
4302 * @stop_ap: Stop operation on the AP interface.
4303 *
4304 * @reconfig_complete: Called after a call to ieee80211_restart_hw() and
4305 * during resume, when the reconfiguration has completed.
4306 * This can help the driver implement the reconfiguration step (and
4307 * indicate mac80211 is ready to receive frames).
4308 * This callback may sleep.
4309 *
4310 * @ipv6_addr_change: IPv6 address assignment on the given interface changed.
4311 * Currently, this is only called for managed or P2P client interfaces.
4312 * This callback is optional; it must not sleep.
4313 *
4314 * @channel_switch_beacon: Starts a channel switch to a new channel.
4315 * Beacons are modified to include CSA or ECSA IEs before calling this
4316 * function. The corresponding count fields in these IEs must be
4317 * decremented, and when they reach 1 the driver must call
4318 * ieee80211_csa_finish(). Drivers which use ieee80211_beacon_get()
4319 * get the csa counter decremented by mac80211, but must check if it is
4320 * 1 using ieee80211_beacon_counter_is_complete() after the beacon has been
4321 * transmitted and then call ieee80211_csa_finish().
4322 * If the CSA count starts as zero or 1, this function will not be called,
4323 * since there won't be any time to beacon before the switch anyway.
4324 * @pre_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4325 * before a channel switch procedure is started (ie. when a STA
4326 * gets a CSA or a userspace initiated channel-switch), allowing
4327 * the driver to prepare for the channel switch.
4328 * @post_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4329 * after a channel switch procedure is completed, allowing the
4330 * driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4331 * @abort_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4332 * when channel switch procedure was aborted, allowing the
4333 * driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4334 * @channel_switch_rx_beacon: This is an optional callback that is called
4335 * when channel switch procedure is in progress and additional beacon with
4336 * CSA IE was received, allowing driver to track changes in count.
4337 * @join_ibss: Join an IBSS (on an IBSS interface); this is called after all
4338 * information in bss_conf is set up and the beacon can be retrieved. A
4339 * channel context is bound before this is called.
4340 * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS again.
4341 *
4342 * @get_expected_throughput: extract the expected throughput towards the
4343 * specified station. The returned value is expressed in Kbps. It returns 0
4344 * if the RC algorithm does not have proper data to provide.
4345 *
4346 * @get_txpower: get current maximum tx power (in dBm) based on configuration
4347 * and hardware limits.
4348 *
4349 * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
4350 * is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
4351 * and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. The
4352 * driver receives a channel-switch request template and the location of
4353 * the switch-timing IE within the template as part of the invocation.
4354 * The template is valid only within the call, and the driver can
4355 * optionally copy the skb for further re-use.
4356 * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
4357 * peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
4358 * @tdls_recv_channel_switch: a TDLS channel-switch related frame (request or
4359 * response) has been received from a remote peer. The driver gets
4360 * parameters parsed from the incoming frame and may use them to continue
4361 * an ongoing channel-switch operation. In addition, a channel-switch
4362 * response template is provided, together with the location of the
4363 * switch-timing IE within the template. The skb can only be used within
4364 * the function call.
4365 *
4366 * @wake_tx_queue: Called when new packets have been added to the queue.
4367 * @sync_rx_queues: Process all pending frames in RSS queues. This is a
4368 * synchronization which is needed in case driver has in its RSS queues
4369 * pending frames that were received prior to the control path action
4370 * currently taken (e.g. disassociation) but are not processed yet.
4371 *
4372 * @start_nan: join an existing NAN cluster, or create a new one.
4373 * @stop_nan: leave the NAN cluster.
4374 * @nan_change_conf: change NAN configuration. The data in cfg80211_nan_conf
4375 * contains full new configuration and changes specify which parameters
4376 * are changed with respect to the last NAN config.
4377 * The driver gets both full configuration and the changed parameters since
4378 * some devices may need the full configuration while others need only the
4379 * changed parameters.
4380 * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns 0 on success. The data in
4381 * cfg80211_nan_func must not be referenced outside the scope of
4382 * this call.
4383 * @del_nan_func: Remove a NAN function. The driver must call
4384 * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated() with
4385 * NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST reason code upon removal.
4386 * @can_aggregate_in_amsdu: Called in order to determine if HW supports
4387 * aggregating two specific frames in the same A-MSDU. The relation
4388 * between the skbs should be symmetric and transitive. Note that while
4389 * skb is always a real frame, head may or may not be an A-MSDU.
4390 * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
4391 * Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
4392 *
4393 * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) (this call can sleep)
4394 * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement (this call can sleep)
4395 * @set_tid_config: Apply TID specific configurations. This callback may sleep.
4396 * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer.
4397 * This callback may sleep.
4398 * @update_vif_offload: Update virtual interface offload flags
4399 * This callback may sleep.
4400 * @sta_set_4addr: Called to notify the driver when a station starts/stops using
4401 * 4-address mode
4402 * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
4403 * @sta_set_decap_offload: Called to notify the driver when a station is allowed
4404 * to use rx decapsulation offload
4405 * @add_twt_setup: Update hw with TWT agreement parameters received from the peer.
4406 * This callback allows the hw to check if requested parameters
4407 * are supported and if there is enough room for a new agreement.
4408 * The hw is expected to set agreement result in the req_type field of
4409 * twt structure.
4410 * @twt_teardown_request: Update the hw with TWT teardown request received
4411 * from the peer.
4412 * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for
4413 * radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit
4414 * or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
4415 * Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
4416 * switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
4417 * radar channel.
4418 * The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to
4419 * disable background CAC/radar detection.
4420 * @net_fill_forward_path: Called from .ndo_fill_forward_path in order to
4421 * resolve a path for hardware flow offloading
4422 * @can_activate_links: Checks if a specific active_links bitmap is
4423 * supported by the driver.
4424 * @change_vif_links: Change the valid links on an interface, note that while
4425 * removing the old link information is still valid (link_conf pointer),
4426 * but may immediately disappear after the function returns. The old or
4427 * new links bitmaps may be 0 if going from/to a non-MLO situation.
4428 * The @old array contains pointers to the old bss_conf structures
4429 * that were already removed, in case they're needed.
4430 * This callback can sleep.
4431 * @change_sta_links: Change the valid links of a station, similar to
4432 * @change_vif_links. This callback can sleep.
4433 * Note that a sta can also be inserted or removed with valid links,
4434 * i.e. passed to @sta_add/@sta_state with sta->valid_links not zero.
4435 * In fact, cannot change from having valid_links and not having them.
4436 * @set_hw_timestamp: Enable/disable HW timestamping of TM/FTM frames. This is
4437 * not restored at HW reset by mac80211 so drivers need to take care of
4438 * that.
4439 * @net_setup_tc: Called from .ndo_setup_tc in order to prepare hardware
4440 * flow offloading for flows originating from the vif.
4441 * Note that the driver must not assume that the vif driver_data is valid
4442 * at this point, since the callback can be called during netdev teardown.
4443 * @can_neg_ttlm: for managed interface, requests the driver to determine
4444 * if the requested TID-To-Link mapping can be accepted or not.
4445 * If it's not accepted the driver may suggest a preferred mapping and
4446 * modify @ttlm parameter with the suggested TID-to-Link mapping.
4447 */
4448 struct ieee80211_ops {
4449 void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4450 struct ieee80211_tx_control *control,
4451 struct sk_buff *skb);
4452 int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4453 void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool suspend);
4454 #ifdef CONFIG_PM
4455 int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan);
4456 int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4457 void (*set_wakeup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool enabled);
4458 #endif
4459 int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4460 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4461 int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4462 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4463 enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p);
4464 void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4465 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4466 int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 changed);
4467 void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4468 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4469 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4470 u64 changed);
4471 void (*vif_cfg_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4472 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4473 u64 changed);
4474 void (*link_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4475 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4476 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4477 u64 changed);
4478
4479 int (*start_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4480 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4481 void (*stop_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4482 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4483
4484 u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4485 struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list);
4486 void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4487 unsigned int changed_flags,
4488 unsigned int *total_flags,
4489 u64 multicast);
4490 void (*config_iface_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4491 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4492 unsigned int filter_flags,
4493 unsigned int changed_flags);
4494 int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4495 bool set);
4496 int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd,
4497 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4498 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key);
4499 void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4500 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4501 struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf,
4502 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4503 u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key);
4504 void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4505 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4506 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4507 void (*set_default_unicast_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4508 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int idx);
4509 int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4510 struct ieee80211_scan_request *req);
4511 void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4512 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4513 int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4514 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4515 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req,
4516 struct ieee80211_scan_ies *ies);
4517 int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4518 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4519 void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4520 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4521 const u8 *mac_addr);
4522 void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4523 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4524 int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4525 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats);
4526 void (*get_key_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4527 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
4528 struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
4529 int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4530 int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4531 int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4532 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4533 int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4534 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4535 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
4536 void (*vif_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4537 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4538 void (*link_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4539 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4540 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4541 struct dentry *dir);
4542 void (*sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4543 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4544 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4545 struct dentry *dir);
4546 void (*link_sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4547 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4548 struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
4549 struct dentry *dir);
4550 #endif
4551 void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4552 enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4553 int (*sta_set_txpwr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4554 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4555 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4556 int (*sta_state)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4557 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4558 enum ieee80211_sta_state old_state,
4559 enum ieee80211_sta_state new_state);
4560 void (*sta_pre_rcu_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4561 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4562 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4563 void (*sta_rc_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4564 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4565 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4566 u32 changed);
4567 void (*sta_rate_tbl_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4568 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4569 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4570 void (*sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4571 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4572 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4573 struct station_info *sinfo);
4574 int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4575 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4576 unsigned int link_id, u16 ac,
4577 const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params);
4578 u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4579 void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4580 u64 tsf);
4581 void (*offset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4582 s64 offset);
4583 void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4584 int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4585
4586 /**
4587 * @ampdu_action:
4588 * Perform a certain A-MPDU action.
4589 * The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want
4590 * the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through
4591 * ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
4592 * When the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL the driver
4593 * may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than @buf_size
4594 * nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the
4595 * buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be
4596 * possible with a buf_size of 8:
4597 *
4598 * - ``TX: 1.....7``
4599 * - ``RX: 2....7`` (lost frame #1)
4600 * - ``TX: 8..1...``
4601 *
4602 * which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the
4603 * buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be:
4604 *
4605 * - ``TX: 1 or``
4606 * - ``TX: 18 or``
4607 * - ``TX: 81``
4608 *
4609 * Even ``189`` would be wrong since 1 could be lost again.
4610 *
4611 * Returns a negative error code on failure. The driver may return
4612 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE for %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START
4613 * if the session can start immediately.
4614 *
4615 * The callback can sleep.
4616 */
4617 int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4618 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4619 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params *params);
4620 int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx,
4621 struct survey_info *survey);
4622 void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4623 void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, s16 coverage_class);
4624 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4625 int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4626 void *data, int len);
4627 int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb,
4628 struct netlink_callback *cb,
4629 void *data, int len);
4630 #endif
4631 void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4632 u32 queues, bool drop);
4633 void (*flush_sta)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4634 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4635 void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4636 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4637 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4638 int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4639 int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4640
4641 int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4642 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4643 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4644 int duration,
4645 enum ieee80211_roc_type type);
4646 int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4647 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4648 int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx);
4649 void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4650 u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max);
4651 bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4652 int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4653 const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4654 void (*event_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4655 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4656 const struct ieee80211_event *event);
4657
4658 void (*allow_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4659 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4660 u16 tids, int num_frames,
4661 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4662 bool more_data);
4663 void (*release_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4664 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4665 u16 tids, int num_frames,
4666 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4667 bool more_data);
4668
4669 int (*get_et_sset_count)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4670 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int sset);
4671 void (*get_et_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4672 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4673 struct ethtool_stats *stats, u64 *data);
4674 void (*get_et_strings)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4675 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4676 u32 sset, u8 *data);
4677
4678 void (*mgd_prepare_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4679 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4680 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4681 void (*mgd_complete_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4682 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4683 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4684
4685 void (*mgd_protect_tdls_discover)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4686 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4687 unsigned int link_id);
4688
4689 int (*add_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4690 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4691 void (*remove_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4692 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4693 void (*change_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4694 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
4695 u32 changed);
4696 int (*assign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4697 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4698 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4699 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4700 void (*unassign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4701 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4702 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4703 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4704 int (*switch_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4705 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
4706 int n_vifs,
4707 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
4708
4709 void (*reconfig_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4710 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type reconfig_type);
4711
4712 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_IPV6)
4713 void (*ipv6_addr_change)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4714 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4715 struct inet6_dev *idev);
4716 #endif
4717 void (*channel_switch_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4718 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4719 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4720 int (*pre_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4721 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4722 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4723
4724 int (*post_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4725 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4726 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4727 void (*abort_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4728 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4729 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4730 void (*channel_switch_rx_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4731 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4732 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4733
4734 int (*join_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4735 void (*leave_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4736 u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4737 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4738 int (*get_txpower)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4739 int *dbm);
4740
4741 int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4742 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4743 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 oper_class,
4744 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4745 struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb, u32 ch_sw_tm_ie);
4746 void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4747 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4748 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4749 void (*tdls_recv_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4750 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4751 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params *params);
4752
4753 void (*wake_tx_queue)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4754 struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
4755 void (*sync_rx_queues)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4756
4757 int (*start_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4758 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4759 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4760 int (*stop_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4761 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4762 int (*nan_change_conf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4763 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4764 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, u32 changes);
4765 int (*add_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4766 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4767 const struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4768 void (*del_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4769 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4770 u8 instance_id);
4771 bool (*can_aggregate_in_amsdu)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4772 struct sk_buff *head,
4773 struct sk_buff *skb);
4774 int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4775 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4776 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4777 int (*start_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4778 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4779 void (*abort_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4780 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4781 int (*set_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4782 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4783 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4784 struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4785 int (*reset_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4786 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4787 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tids);
4788 void (*update_vif_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4789 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4790 void (*sta_set_4addr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4791 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4792 int (*set_sar_specs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4793 const struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
4794 void (*sta_set_decap_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4795 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4796 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4797 void (*add_twt_setup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4798 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4799 struct ieee80211_twt_setup *twt);
4800 void (*twt_teardown_request)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4801 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 flowid);
4802 int (*set_radar_background)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4803 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4804 int (*net_fill_forward_path)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4805 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4806 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4807 struct net_device_path_ctx *ctx,
4808 struct net_device_path *path);
4809 bool (*can_activate_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4810 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4811 u16 active_links);
4812 int (*change_vif_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4813 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4814 u16 old_links, u16 new_links,
4815 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *old[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]);
4816 int (*change_sta_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4817 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4818 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4819 u16 old_links, u16 new_links);
4820 int (*set_hw_timestamp)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4821 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4822 struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp *hwts);
4823 int (*net_setup_tc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4824 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4825 struct net_device *dev,
4826 enum tc_setup_type type,
4827 void *type_data);
4828 enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res
4829 (*can_neg_ttlm)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4830 struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm *ttlm);
4831 };
4832
4833 /**
4834 * ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm - Allocate a new hardware device
4835 *
4836 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4837 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4838 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4839 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4840 * @priv_data_len.
4841 *
4842 * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4843 * @ops: callbacks for this device
4844 * @requested_name: Requested name for this device.
4845 * NULL is valid value, and means use the default naming (phy%d)
4846 *
4847 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4848 */
4849 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(size_t priv_data_len,
4850 const struct ieee80211_ops *ops,
4851 const char *requested_name);
4852
4853 /**
4854 * ieee80211_alloc_hw - Allocate a new hardware device
4855 *
4856 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4857 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4858 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4859 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4860 * @priv_data_len.
4861 *
4862 * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4863 * @ops: callbacks for this device
4864 *
4865 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4866 */
4867 static inline
ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,const struct ieee80211_ops * ops)4868 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,
4869 const struct ieee80211_ops *ops)
4870 {
4871 return ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(priv_data_len, ops, NULL);
4872 }
4873
4874 /**
4875 * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device
4876 *
4877 * You must call this function before any other functions in
4878 * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you
4879 * need to fill the contained wiphy's information.
4880 *
4881 * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw()
4882 *
4883 * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
4884 */
4885 int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4886
4887 /**
4888 * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description
4889 * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec
4890 * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds
4891 * (full cycle, ie. one off + one on period)
4892 */
4893 struct ieee80211_tpt_blink {
4894 int throughput;
4895 int blink_time;
4896 };
4897
4898 /**
4899 * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags
4900 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio
4901 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working
4902 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one
4903 * interface is connected in some way, including being an AP
4904 */
4905 enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags {
4906 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO = BIT(0),
4907 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK = BIT(1),
4908 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED = BIT(2),
4909 };
4910
4911 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4912 const char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4913 const char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4914 const char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4915 const char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4916 const char *
4917 __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4918 unsigned int flags,
4919 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4920 unsigned int blink_table_len);
4921 #endif
4922 /**
4923 * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED
4924 *
4925 * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4926 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4927 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4928 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4929 *
4930 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4931 *
4932 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4933 */
ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)4934 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4935 {
4936 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4937 return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw);
4938 #else
4939 return NULL;
4940 #endif
4941 }
4942
4943 /**
4944 * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED
4945 *
4946 * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4947 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4948 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4949 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4950 *
4951 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4952 *
4953 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4954 */
ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)4955 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4956 {
4957 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4958 return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw);
4959 #else
4960 return NULL;
4961 #endif
4962 }
4963
4964 /**
4965 * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED
4966 *
4967 * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4968 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4969 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4970 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4971 *
4972 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4973 *
4974 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4975 */
ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)4976 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4977 {
4978 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4979 return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw);
4980 #else
4981 return NULL;
4982 #endif
4983 }
4984
4985 /**
4986 * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED
4987 *
4988 * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4989 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4990 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4991 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4992 *
4993 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4994 *
4995 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4996 */
ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)4997 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4998 {
4999 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5000 return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw);
5001 #else
5002 return NULL;
5003 #endif
5004 }
5005
5006 /**
5007 * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger
5008 * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for
5009 * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags
5010 * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput
5011 * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table
5012 *
5013 * Return: %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED triggers are
5014 * configured) or the name of the new trigger.
5015 *
5016 * Note: This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw().
5017 */
5018 static inline const char *
ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,unsigned int flags,const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink * blink_table,unsigned int blink_table_len)5019 ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags,
5020 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
5021 unsigned int blink_table_len)
5022 {
5023 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5024 return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table,
5025 blink_table_len);
5026 #else
5027 return NULL;
5028 #endif
5029 }
5030
5031 /**
5032 * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device
5033 *
5034 * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources
5035 * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem.
5036 *
5037 * @hw: the hardware to unregister
5038 */
5039 void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5040
5041 /**
5042 * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor
5043 *
5044 * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the
5045 * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw()
5046 * before calling this function.
5047 *
5048 * @hw: the hardware to free
5049 */
5050 void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5051
5052 /**
5053 * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely
5054 *
5055 * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason
5056 * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state
5057 * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware
5058 * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by
5059 * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all
5060 * internal state that it has prior to calling this function.
5061 *
5062 * @hw: the hardware to restart
5063 */
5064 void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5065
5066 /**
5067 * ieee80211_rx_list - receive frame and store processed skbs in a list
5068 *
5069 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5070 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5071 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5072 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5073 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5074 *
5075 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5076 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5077 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5078 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5079 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5080 *
5081 * This function must be called with BHs disabled and RCU read lock
5082 *
5083 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5084 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
5085 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5086 * @list: the destination list
5087 */
5088 void ieee80211_rx_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5089 struct sk_buff *skb, struct list_head *list);
5090
5091 /**
5092 * ieee80211_rx_napi - receive frame from NAPI context
5093 *
5094 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5095 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5096 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5097 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5098 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5099 *
5100 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5101 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5102 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5103 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5104 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5105 *
5106 * This function must be called with BHs disabled.
5107 *
5108 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5109 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
5110 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5111 * @napi: the NAPI context
5112 */
5113 void ieee80211_rx_napi(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5114 struct sk_buff *skb, struct napi_struct *napi);
5115
5116 /**
5117 * ieee80211_rx - receive frame
5118 *
5119 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5120 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5121 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5122 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5123 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5124 *
5125 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5126 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5127 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5128 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5129 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5130 *
5131 * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni().
5132 *
5133 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5134 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5135 */
ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)5136 static inline void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb)
5137 {
5138 ieee80211_rx_napi(hw, NULL, skb, NULL);
5139 }
5140
5141 /**
5142 * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame
5143 *
5144 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context
5145 * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5146 *
5147 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not
5148 * be mixed for a single hardware.Must not run concurrently with
5149 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5150 *
5151 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5152 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5153 */
5154 void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
5155
5156 /**
5157 * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context)
5158 *
5159 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context
5160 * (internally disables bottom halves).
5161 *
5162 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may
5163 * not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5164 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5165 *
5166 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5167 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5168 */
ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)5169 static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5170 struct sk_buff *skb)
5171 {
5172 local_bh_disable();
5173 ieee80211_rx(hw, skb);
5174 local_bh_enable();
5175 }
5176
5177 /**
5178 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta
5179 *
5180 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS
5181 * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station
5182 * entering/leaving PS mode.
5183 *
5184 * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled.
5185 *
5186 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against
5187 * each other.
5188 *
5189 * @sta: currently connected sta
5190 * @start: start or stop PS
5191 *
5192 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set.
5193 */
5194 int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start);
5195
5196 /**
5197 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta
5198 * (in process context)
5199 *
5200 * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context
5201 * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still
5202 * applies.
5203 *
5204 * @sta: currently connected sta
5205 * @start: start or stop PS
5206 *
5207 * Return: Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition().
5208 */
ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta * sta,bool start)5209 static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5210 bool start)
5211 {
5212 int ret;
5213
5214 local_bh_disable();
5215 ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start);
5216 local_bh_enable();
5217
5218 return ret;
5219 }
5220
5221 /**
5222 * ieee80211_sta_pspoll - PS-Poll frame received
5223 * @sta: currently connected station
5224 *
5225 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5226 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a PS-Poll frame from a
5227 * connected station was received.
5228 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5229 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(); calls to all three must
5230 * be serialized.
5231 */
5232 void ieee80211_sta_pspoll(struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
5233
5234 /**
5235 * ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger - (potential) U-APSD trigger frame received
5236 * @sta: currently connected station
5237 * @tid: TID of the received (potential) trigger frame
5238 *
5239 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5240 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a (potential) trigger frame
5241 * from a connected station was received.
5242 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5243 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_pspoll(); calls to all three must be
5244 * serialized.
5245 * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS can be passed as the tid if the tid is unknown.
5246 * In this case, mac80211 will not check that this tid maps to an AC
5247 * that is trigger enabled and assume that the caller did the proper
5248 * checks.
5249 */
5250 void ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
5251
5252 /*
5253 * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions.
5254 * This is enough for the radiotap header.
5255 */
5256 #define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM ALIGN(14, 4)
5257
5258 /**
5259 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered - inform mac80211 about driver-buffered frames
5260 * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station
5261 * @tid: the TID that has buffered frames
5262 * @buffered: indicates whether or not frames are buffered for this TID
5263 *
5264 * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing
5265 * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station may still need
5266 * to be told that there are buffered frames via the TIM bit.
5267 *
5268 * This function informs mac80211 whether or not there are frames that are
5269 * buffered in the driver for a given TID; mac80211 can then use this data
5270 * to set the TIM bit (NOTE: This may call back into the driver's set_tim
5271 * call! Beware of the locking!)
5272 *
5273 * If all frames are released to the station (due to PS-poll or uAPSD)
5274 * then the driver needs to inform mac80211 that there no longer are
5275 * frames buffered. However, when the station wakes up mac80211 assumes
5276 * that all buffered frames will be transmitted and clears this data,
5277 * drivers need to make sure they inform mac80211 about all buffered
5278 * frames on the sleep transition (sta_notify() with %STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP).
5279 *
5280 * Note that technically mac80211 only needs to know this per AC, not per
5281 * TID, but since driver buffering will inevitably happen per TID (since
5282 * it is related to aggregation) it is easier to make mac80211 map the
5283 * TID to the AC as required instead of keeping track in all drivers that
5284 * use this API.
5285 */
5286 void ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5287 u8 tid, bool buffered);
5288
5289 /**
5290 * ieee80211_get_tx_rates - get the selected transmit rates for a packet
5291 *
5292 * Call this function in a driver with per-packet rate selection support
5293 * to combine the rate info in the packet tx info with the most recent
5294 * rate selection table for the station entry.
5295 *
5296 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5297 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent.
5298 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
5299 * @dest: buffer for extracted rate/retry information
5300 * @max_rates: maximum number of rates to fetch
5301 */
5302 void ieee80211_get_tx_rates(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5303 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5304 struct sk_buff *skb,
5305 struct ieee80211_tx_rate *dest,
5306 int max_rates);
5307
5308 /**
5309 * ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput - set the expected tpt for a station
5310 *
5311 * Call this function to notify mac80211 about a change in expected throughput
5312 * to a station. A driver for a device that does rate control in firmware can
5313 * call this function when the expected throughput estimate towards a station
5314 * changes. The information is used to tune the CoDel AQM applied to traffic
5315 * going towards that station (which can otherwise be too aggressive and cause
5316 * slow stations to starve).
5317 *
5318 * @pubsta: the station to set throughput for.
5319 * @thr: the current expected throughput in kbps.
5320 */
5321 void ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5322 u32 thr);
5323
5324 /**
5325 * ieee80211_tx_rate_update - transmit rate update callback
5326 *
5327 * Drivers should call this functions with a non-NULL pub sta
5328 * This function can be used in drivers that does not have provision
5329 * in updating the tx rate in data path.
5330 *
5331 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5332 * @pubsta: the station to update the tx rate for.
5333 * @info: tx status information
5334 */
5335 void ieee80211_tx_rate_update(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5336 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5337 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info);
5338
5339 /**
5340 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb - transmit status callback
5341 *
5342 * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been
5343 * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for
5344 * multicast frames but this can affect statistics.
5345 *
5346 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5347 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls
5348 * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe()
5349 * may not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5350 * ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni().
5351 *
5352 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5353 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5354 */
5355 void ieee80211_tx_status_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5356 struct sk_buff *skb);
5357
5358 /**
5359 * ieee80211_tx_status_ext - extended transmit status callback
5360 *
5361 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status_skb()
5362 * in drivers that may want to provide extra information that does not
5363 * fit into &struct ieee80211_tx_info.
5364 *
5365 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5366 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5367 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5368 *
5369 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5370 * @status: tx status information
5371 */
5372 void ieee80211_tx_status_ext(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5373 struct ieee80211_tx_status *status);
5374
5375 /**
5376 * ieee80211_tx_status_noskb - transmit status callback without skb
5377 *
5378 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status_skb()
5379 * in drivers that cannot reliably map tx status information back to
5380 * specific skbs.
5381 *
5382 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5383 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5384 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5385 *
5386 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5387 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent
5388 * (NULL for multicast packets)
5389 * @info: tx status information
5390 */
ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_sta * sta,struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)5391 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5392 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5393 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
5394 {
5395 struct ieee80211_tx_status status = {
5396 .sta = sta,
5397 .info = info,
5398 };
5399
5400 ieee80211_tx_status_ext(hw, &status);
5401 }
5402
5403 /**
5404 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context)
5405 *
5406 * Like ieee80211_tx_status_skb() but can be called in process context.
5407 *
5408 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_skb() and
5409 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed
5410 * for a single hardware.
5411 *
5412 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5413 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5414 */
ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)5415 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5416 struct sk_buff *skb)
5417 {
5418 local_bh_disable();
5419 ieee80211_tx_status_skb(hw, skb);
5420 local_bh_enable();
5421 }
5422
5423 /**
5424 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback
5425 *
5426 * Like ieee80211_tx_status_skb() but can be called in IRQ context
5427 * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5428 *
5429 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_skb() and
5430 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5431 *
5432 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5433 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5434 */
5435 void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5436 struct sk_buff *skb);
5437
5438 /**
5439 * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station
5440 *
5441 * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding
5442 * connected STA.
5443 *
5444 * @sta: the non-responding connected sta
5445 * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response
5446 */
5447 void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets);
5448
5449 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM 2
5450
5451 /**
5452 * struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets - mutable beacon offsets
5453 * @tim_offset: position of TIM element
5454 * @tim_length: size of TIM element
5455 * @cntdwn_counter_offs: array of IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM offsets
5456 * to countdown counters. This array can contain zero values which
5457 * should be ignored.
5458 * @mbssid_off: position of the multiple bssid element
5459 */
5460 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets {
5461 u16 tim_offset;
5462 u16 tim_length;
5463
5464 u16 cntdwn_counter_offs[IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM];
5465 u16 mbssid_off;
5466 };
5467
5468 /**
5469 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template - beacon template generation function
5470 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5471 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5472 * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5473 * receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5474 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5475 * that is not associated with AP MLD).
5476 *
5477 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5478 * obtain the beacon template.
5479 *
5480 * This function should be used if the beacon frames are generated by the
5481 * device, and then the driver must use the returned beacon as the template
5482 * The driver or the device are responsible to update the DTIM and, when
5483 * applicable, the CSA count.
5484 *
5485 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5486 *
5487 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5488 */
5489 struct sk_buff *
5490 ieee80211_beacon_get_template(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5491 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5492 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5493 unsigned int link_id);
5494
5495 /**
5496 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index - EMA beacon template generation
5497 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5498 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5499 * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5500 * receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5501 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP).
5502 * @ema_index: index of the beacon in the EMA set.
5503 *
5504 * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5505 * but returns a beacon template which includes multiple BSSID element at the
5506 * requested index.
5507 *
5508 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL indicates the end of EMA templates.
5509 */
5510 struct sk_buff *
5511 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5512 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5513 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5514 unsigned int link_id, u8 ema_index);
5515
5516 /**
5517 * struct ieee80211_ema_beacons - List of EMA beacons
5518 * @cnt: count of EMA beacons.
5519 *
5520 * @bcn: array of EMA beacons.
5521 * @bcn.skb: the skb containing this specific beacon
5522 * @bcn.offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5523 * receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5524 */
5525 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons {
5526 u8 cnt;
5527 struct {
5528 struct sk_buff *skb;
5529 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets offs;
5530 } bcn[];
5531 };
5532
5533 /**
5534 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list - EMA beacon template generation
5535 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5536 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5537 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
5538 *
5539 * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5540 * but allocates and returns a pointer to list of all beacon templates required
5541 * to cover all profiles in the multiple BSSID set. Each template includes only
5542 * one multiple BSSID element.
5543 *
5544 * Driver must call ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list() to free the memory.
5545 *
5546 * Return: EMA beacon templates of type struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *.
5547 * %NULL on error.
5548 */
5549 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *
5550 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5551 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5552 unsigned int link_id);
5553
5554 /**
5555 * ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list - free an EMA beacon template list
5556 * @ema_beacons: list of EMA beacons of type &struct ieee80211_ema_beacons pointers.
5557 *
5558 * This function will free a list previously acquired by calling
5559 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list()
5560 */
5561 void ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list(struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *ema_beacons);
5562
5563 /**
5564 * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function
5565 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5566 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5567 * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset.
5568 * Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5569 * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length,
5570 * (including the ID and length bytes!).
5571 * Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5572 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5573 * that is not associated with AP MLD).
5574 *
5575 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5576 * obtain the beacon frame.
5577 *
5578 * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5579 * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon
5580 * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function exactly
5581 * once before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt).
5582 *
5583 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5584 *
5585 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5586 */
5587 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5588 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5589 u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length,
5590 unsigned int link_id);
5591
5592 /**
5593 * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function
5594 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5595 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5596 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5597 * that is not associated with AP MLD).
5598 *
5599 * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5600 *
5601 * Return: See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5602 */
ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_vif * vif,unsigned int link_id)5603 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5604 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5605 unsigned int link_id)
5606 {
5607 return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL, link_id);
5608 }
5609
5610 /**
5611 * ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn - request mac80211 to decrement the beacon countdown
5612 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5613 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5614 *
5615 * The beacon counter should be updated after each beacon transmission.
5616 * This function is called implicitly when
5617 * ieee80211_beacon_get/ieee80211_beacon_get_tim are called, however if the
5618 * beacon frames are generated by the device, the driver should call this
5619 * function after each beacon transmission to sync mac80211's beacon countdown.
5620 *
5621 * Return: new countdown value
5622 */
5623 u8 ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5624 unsigned int link_id);
5625
5626 /**
5627 * ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn - request mac80211 to set beacon countdown
5628 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5629 * @counter: the new value for the counter
5630 *
5631 * The beacon countdown can be changed by the device, this API should be
5632 * used by the device driver to update csa counter in mac80211.
5633 *
5634 * It should never be used together with ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(),
5635 * as it will cause a race condition around the counter value.
5636 */
5637 void ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 counter);
5638
5639 /**
5640 * ieee80211_csa_finish - notify mac80211 about channel switch
5641 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5642 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5643 *
5644 * After a channel switch announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5645 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5646 * notify mac80211 that the channel can be changed.
5647 */
5648 void ieee80211_csa_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id);
5649
5650 /**
5651 * ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete - find out if countdown reached 1
5652 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5653 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5654 *
5655 * Return: %true if the countdown reached 1, %false otherwise
5656 */
5657 bool ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5658 unsigned int link_id);
5659
5660 /**
5661 * ieee80211_color_change_finish - notify mac80211 about color change
5662 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5663 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5664 *
5665 * After a color change announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5666 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5667 * notify mac80211 that the color can be changed
5668 */
5669 void ieee80211_color_change_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 link_id);
5670
5671 /**
5672 * ieee80211_proberesp_get - retrieve a Probe Response template
5673 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5674 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5675 *
5676 * Creates a Probe Response template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5677 * hardware. The destination address should be set by the caller.
5678 *
5679 * Can only be called in AP mode.
5680 *
5681 * Return: The Probe Response template. %NULL on error.
5682 */
5683 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_proberesp_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5684 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5685
5686 /**
5687 * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template
5688 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5689 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5690 *
5691 * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to
5692 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5693 * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used.
5694 *
5695 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5696 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit.
5697 *
5698 * Return: The PS Poll template. %NULL on error.
5699 */
5700 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5701 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5702
5703 /**
5704 * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template
5705 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5706 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5707 * @link_id: If the vif is an MLD, get a frame with the link addresses
5708 * for the given link ID. For a link_id < 0 you get a frame with
5709 * MLD addresses, however useful that might be.
5710 * @qos_ok: QoS NDP is acceptable to the caller, this should be set
5711 * if at all possible
5712 *
5713 * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to
5714 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5715 * BSSID and address is used.
5716 *
5717 * If @qos_ndp is set and the association is to an AP with QoS/WMM, the
5718 * returned packet will be QoS NDP.
5719 *
5720 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5721 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields.
5722 *
5723 * Return: The nullfunc template. %NULL on error.
5724 */
5725 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5726 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5727 int link_id, bool qos_ok);
5728
5729 /**
5730 * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
5731 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5732 * @src_addr: source MAC address
5733 * @ssid: SSID buffer
5734 * @ssid_len: length of SSID
5735 * @tailroom: tailroom to reserve at end of SKB for IEs
5736 *
5737 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5738 * hardware.
5739 *
5740 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
5741 */
5742 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5743 const u8 *src_addr,
5744 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
5745 size_t tailroom);
5746
5747 /**
5748 * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function
5749 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5750 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5751 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5752 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5753 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5754 * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame.
5755 *
5756 * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5757 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5758 * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5759 * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed.
5760 */
5761 void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5762 const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5763 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5764 struct ieee80211_rts *rts);
5765
5766 /**
5767 * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame
5768 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5769 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5770 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5771 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5772 *
5773 * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5774 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5775 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5776 *
5777 * Return: The duration.
5778 */
5779 __le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5780 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len,
5781 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5782
5783 /**
5784 * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function
5785 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5786 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5787 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5788 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5789 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5790 * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame.
5791 *
5792 * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5793 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5794 * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5795 * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed.
5796 */
5797 void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5798 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5799 const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5800 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5801 struct ieee80211_cts *cts);
5802
5803 /**
5804 * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame
5805 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5806 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5807 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5808 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5809 *
5810 * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5811 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5812 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5813 *
5814 * Return: The duration.
5815 */
5816 __le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5817 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5818 size_t frame_len,
5819 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5820
5821 /**
5822 * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame
5823 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5824 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5825 * @band: the band to calculate the frame duration on
5826 * @frame_len: the length of the frame.
5827 * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted.
5828 *
5829 * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its
5830 * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps).
5831 *
5832 * Return: The duration.
5833 */
5834 __le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5835 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5836 enum nl80211_band band,
5837 size_t frame_len,
5838 struct ieee80211_rate *rate);
5839
5840 /**
5841 * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames
5842 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5843 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5844 *
5845 * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If
5846 * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast
5847 * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host
5848 * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered
5849 * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame.
5850 *
5851 * Return: A pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more buffered
5852 * frames are available.
5853 *
5854 * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was
5855 * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus
5856 * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns
5857 * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver
5858 * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to
5859 * use common code for all beacons.
5860 */
5861 struct sk_buff *
5862 ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5863
5864 /**
5865 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32
5866 *
5867 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32.
5868 *
5869 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5870 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5871 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5872 */
5873 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5874 u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5875
5876 /**
5877 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key
5878 *
5879 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken
5880 * from the given packet.
5881 *
5882 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5883 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted
5884 * with this P1K
5885 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5886 */
ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf * keyconf,struct sk_buff * skb,u16 * p1k)5887 static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5888 struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k)
5889 {
5890 struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data;
5891 const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control);
5892 u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]);
5893
5894 ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k);
5895 }
5896
5897 /**
5898 * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX
5899 *
5900 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32
5901 * and transmitter address.
5902 *
5903 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5904 * @ta: TA that will be used with the key
5905 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5906 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5907 */
5908 void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5909 const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5910
5911 /**
5912 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key
5913 *
5914 * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values
5915 * in the packet.
5916 *
5917 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5918 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be
5919 * encrypted with this key
5920 * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes
5921 */
5922 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5923 struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k);
5924
5925 /**
5926 * ieee80211_tkip_add_iv - write TKIP IV and Ext. IV to pos
5927 *
5928 * @pos: start of crypto header
5929 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5930 * @pn: PN to add
5931 *
5932 * Returns: pointer to the octet following IVs (i.e. beginning of
5933 * the packet payload)
5934 *
5935 * This function writes the tkip IV value to pos (which should
5936 * point to the crypto header)
5937 */
5938 u8 *ieee80211_tkip_add_iv(u8 *pos, struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, u64 pn);
5939
5940 /**
5941 * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter
5942 *
5943 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5944 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5945 * the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5946 * CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5947 * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data
5948 *
5949 * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs
5950 * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done
5951 * by the device and not by mac80211.
5952 *
5953 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5954 * can be done concurrently.
5955 */
5956 void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5957 int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5958
5959 /**
5960 * ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq - set key RX sequence counter
5961 *
5962 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5963 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5964 * the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5965 * CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5966 * @seq: new sequence data
5967 *
5968 * This function allows a driver to set the current RX IV/PNs for the
5969 * given key. This is useful when resuming from WoWLAN sleep and GTK
5970 * rekey may have been done while suspended. It should not be called
5971 * if IV checking is done by the device and not by mac80211.
5972 *
5973 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5974 * can be done concurrently.
5975 */
5976 void ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5977 int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5978
5979 /**
5980 * ieee80211_remove_key - remove the given key
5981 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5982 *
5983 * Context: Must be called with the wiphy mutex held.
5984 *
5985 * Remove the given key. If the key was uploaded to the hardware at the
5986 * time this function is called, it is not deleted in the hardware but
5987 * instead assumed to have been removed already.
5988 */
5989 void ieee80211_remove_key(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5990
5991 /**
5992 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add - add a GTK key from rekeying during WoWLAN
5993 * @vif: the virtual interface to add the key on
5994 * @keyconf: new key data
5995 * @link_id: the link id of the key or -1 for non-MLO
5996 *
5997 * When GTK rekeying was done while the system was suspended, (a) new
5998 * key(s) will be available. These will be needed by mac80211 for proper
5999 * RX processing, so this function allows setting them.
6000 *
6001 * Return: the newly allocated key structure, which will have
6002 * similar contents to the passed key configuration but point to
6003 * mac80211-owned memory. In case of errors, the function returns an
6004 * ERR_PTR(), use IS_ERR() etc.
6005 *
6006 * Note that this function assumes the key isn't added to hardware
6007 * acceleration, so no TX will be done with the key. Since it's a GTK
6008 * on managed (station) networks, this is true anyway. If the driver
6009 * calls this function from the resume callback and subsequently uses
6010 * the return code 1 to reconfigure the device, this key will be part
6011 * of the reconfiguration.
6012 *
6013 * Note that the driver should also call ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq()
6014 * for the new key for each TID to set up sequence counters properly.
6015 *
6016 * IMPORTANT: If this replaces a key that is present in the hardware,
6017 * then it will attempt to remove it during this call. In many cases
6018 * this isn't what you want, so call ieee80211_remove_key() first for
6019 * the key that's being replaced.
6020 */
6021 struct ieee80211_key_conf *
6022 ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6023 struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
6024 int link_id);
6025
6026 /**
6027 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying
6028 * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on
6029 * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association
6030 * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying
6031 * @gfp: allocation flags
6032 */
6033 void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid,
6034 const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
6035
6036 /**
6037 * ieee80211_key_mic_failure - increment MIC failure counter for the key
6038 *
6039 * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
6040 * at the same time.
6041 *
6042 * @keyconf: the key in question
6043 */
6044 void ieee80211_key_mic_failure(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
6045
6046 /**
6047 * ieee80211_key_replay - increment replay counter for the key
6048 *
6049 * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
6050 * at the same time.
6051 *
6052 * @keyconf: the key in question
6053 */
6054 void ieee80211_key_replay(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
6055
6056 /**
6057 * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue
6058 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6059 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6060 *
6061 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
6062 */
6063 void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6064
6065 /**
6066 * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue
6067 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6068 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6069 *
6070 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
6071 */
6072 void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6073
6074 /**
6075 * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue
6076 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6077 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6078 *
6079 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_queue_stopped.
6080 *
6081 * Return: %true if the queue is stopped. %false otherwise.
6082 */
6083
6084 int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6085
6086 /**
6087 * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues
6088 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6089 *
6090 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_stop_all_queues.
6091 */
6092 void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6093
6094 /**
6095 * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues
6096 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6097 *
6098 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_wake_all_queues.
6099 */
6100 void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6101
6102 /**
6103 * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan
6104 *
6105 * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is
6106 * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify
6107 * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from
6108 * any context, including hardirq context.
6109 *
6110 * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan
6111 * @info: information about the completed scan
6112 */
6113 void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6114 struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
6115
6116 /**
6117 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan
6118 *
6119 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the
6120 * driver whenever there are new scan results available.
6121 *
6122 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
6123 */
6124 void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6125
6126 /**
6127 * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped
6128 *
6129 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by
6130 * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task.
6131 * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan
6132 * while associating, for instance.
6133 *
6134 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
6135 */
6136 void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6137
6138 /**
6139 * enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags - interface iteration flags
6140 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL: Iterate over all interfaces that have
6141 * been added to the driver; However, note that during hardware
6142 * reconfiguration (after restart_hw) it will iterate over a new
6143 * interface and over all the existing interfaces even if they
6144 * haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
6145 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL: During resume, iterate over all
6146 * interfaces, even if they haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
6147 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE: Iterate only active interfaces (netdev is up).
6148 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER: Skip any interfaces where SDATA
6149 * is not in the driver. This may fix crashes during firmware recovery
6150 * for instance.
6151 */
6152 enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags {
6153 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL = 0,
6154 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL = BIT(0),
6155 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE = BIT(1),
6156 IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER = BIT(2),
6157 };
6158
6159 /**
6160 * ieee80211_iterate_interfaces - iterate interfaces
6161 *
6162 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6163 * hardware and calls the callback for them. This includes active as well as
6164 * inactive interfaces. This function allows the iterator function to sleep.
6165 * Will iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6166 *
6167 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6168 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6169 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6170 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6171 */
6172 void ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
6173 void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
6174 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6175 void *data);
6176
6177 /**
6178 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces
6179 *
6180 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6181 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6182 * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator
6183 * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can
6184 * be used.
6185 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6186 *
6187 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6188 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6189 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6190 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6191 */
6192 static inline void
ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,u32 iter_flags,void (* iterator)(void * data,u8 * mac,struct ieee80211_vif * vif),void * data)6193 ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
6194 void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
6195 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6196 void *data)
6197 {
6198 ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw,
6199 iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE,
6200 iterator, data);
6201 }
6202
6203 /**
6204 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces
6205 *
6206 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6207 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6208 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
6209 * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead.
6210 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6211 *
6212 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6213 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6214 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6215 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6216 */
6217 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6218 u32 iter_flags,
6219 void (*iterator)(void *data,
6220 u8 *mac,
6221 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6222 void *data);
6223
6224 /**
6225 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx - iterate active interfaces
6226 *
6227 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6228 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6229 * This version can only be used while holding the wiphy mutex.
6230 *
6231 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6232 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6233 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6234 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6235 */
6236 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6237 u32 iter_flags,
6238 void (*iterator)(void *data,
6239 u8 *mac,
6240 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6241 void *data);
6242
6243 /**
6244 * ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic - iterate stations
6245 *
6246 * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
6247 * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
6248 * function for them.
6249 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
6250 *
6251 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6252 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6253 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6254 */
6255 void ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6256 void (*iterator)(void *data,
6257 struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
6258 void *data);
6259
6260 /**
6261 * ieee80211_iterate_stations_mtx - iterate stations
6262 *
6263 * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
6264 * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
6265 * function for them. This version can only be used while holding the wiphy
6266 * mutex.
6267 *
6268 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6269 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6270 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6271 */
6272 void ieee80211_iterate_stations_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6273 void (*iterator)(void *data,
6274 struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
6275 void *data);
6276
6277 /**
6278 * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6279 *
6280 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue.
6281 * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be.
6282 *
6283 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6284 * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue
6285 */
6286 void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work);
6287
6288 /**
6289 * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6290 *
6291 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211
6292 * workqueue.
6293 *
6294 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6295 * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue
6296 * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
6297 */
6298 void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6299 struct delayed_work *dwork,
6300 unsigned long delay);
6301
6302 /**
6303 * ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer - Refresh a tx agg session timer.
6304 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6305 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6306 *
6307 * This function allows low level driver to refresh tx agg session timer
6308 * to maintain BA session, the session level will still be managed by the
6309 * mac80211.
6310 *
6311 * Note: must be called in an RCU critical section.
6312 */
6313 void ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6314 u16 tid);
6315
6316 /**
6317 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session.
6318 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6319 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6320 * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs)
6321 *
6322 * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise
6323 *
6324 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6325 * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6326 * will be managed by the mac80211.
6327 */
6328 int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid,
6329 u16 timeout);
6330
6331 /**
6332 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate.
6333 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6334 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6335 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6336 *
6337 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6338 * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called
6339 * from any context.
6340 */
6341 void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6342 u16 tid);
6343
6344 /**
6345 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session.
6346 * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop
6347 * @tid: the TID to stop BA.
6348 *
6349 * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active
6350 *
6351 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6352 * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6353 * will be managed by the mac80211.
6354 */
6355 int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid);
6356
6357 /**
6358 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate.
6359 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6360 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6361 * @tid: the desired TID to BA on.
6362 *
6363 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6364 * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It
6365 * can be called from any context.
6366 */
6367 void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6368 u16 tid);
6369
6370 /**
6371 * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station
6372 *
6373 * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on
6374 * @addr: station's address
6375 *
6376 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6377 *
6378 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6379 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6380 */
6381 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6382 const u8 *addr);
6383
6384 /**
6385 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware
6386 *
6387 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6388 * @addr: remote station's address
6389 * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'.
6390 *
6391 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6392 *
6393 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6394 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6395 *
6396 * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get
6397 * the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'.
6398 * We can have multiple STA associated with multiple
6399 * logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another
6400 * BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first).
6401 * In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL
6402 * is not reliable.
6403 *
6404 * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible.
6405 */
6406 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6407 const u8 *addr,
6408 const u8 *localaddr);
6409
6410 /**
6411 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs - find STA by link addresses
6412 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6413 * @addr: remote station's link address
6414 * @localaddr: local link address, use %NULL for any (but avoid that)
6415 * @link_id: pointer to obtain the link ID if the STA is found,
6416 * may be %NULL if the link ID is not needed
6417 *
6418 * Obtain the STA by link address, must use RCU protection.
6419 *
6420 * Return: pointer to STA if found, otherwise %NULL.
6421 */
6422 struct ieee80211_sta *
6423 ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6424 const u8 *addr,
6425 const u8 *localaddr,
6426 unsigned int *link_id);
6427
6428 /**
6429 * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up
6430 * @hw: the hardware
6431 * @pubsta: the station
6432 * @block: whether to block or unblock
6433 *
6434 * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues
6435 * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before
6436 * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be
6437 * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected
6438 * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag.
6439 *
6440 * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free
6441 * manner.
6442 *
6443 * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames
6444 * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not
6445 * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call
6446 * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to
6447 * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the
6448 * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must
6449 * call this function again to unblock the station. That will
6450 * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if
6451 * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also
6452 * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver
6453 * will be notified that the station woke up some time after
6454 * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually
6455 * woke up while blocked or not.
6456 */
6457 void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6458 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block);
6459
6460 /**
6461 * ieee80211_sta_eosp - notify mac80211 about end of SP
6462 * @pubsta: the station
6463 *
6464 * When a device transmits frames in a way that it can't tell
6465 * mac80211 in the TX status about the EOSP, it must clear the
6466 * %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP bit and call this function instead.
6467 * This applies for PS-Poll as well as uAPSD.
6468 *
6469 * Note that just like with _tx_status() and _rx() drivers must
6470 * not mix calls to irqsafe/non-irqsafe versions, this function
6471 * must not be mixed with those either. Use the all irqsafe, or
6472 * all non-irqsafe, don't mix!
6473 *
6474 * NB: the _irqsafe version of this function doesn't exist, no
6475 * driver needs it right now. Don't call this function if
6476 * you'd need the _irqsafe version, look at the git history
6477 * and restore the _irqsafe version!
6478 */
6479 void ieee80211_sta_eosp(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6480
6481 /**
6482 * ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc - ask mac80211 to send NDP with EOSP
6483 * @pubsta: the station
6484 * @tid: the tid of the NDP
6485 *
6486 * Sometimes the device understands that it needs to close
6487 * the Service Period unexpectedly. This can happen when
6488 * sending frames that are filling holes in the BA window.
6489 * In this case, the device can ask mac80211 to send a
6490 * Nullfunc frame with EOSP set. When that happens, the
6491 * driver must have called ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() to
6492 * let mac80211 know that there are no buffered frames any
6493 * more, otherwise mac80211 will get the more_data bit wrong.
6494 * The low level driver must have made sure that the frame
6495 * will be sent despite the station being in power-save.
6496 * Mac80211 won't call allow_buffered_frames().
6497 * Note that calling this function, doesn't exempt the driver
6498 * from closing the EOSP properly, it will still have to call
6499 * ieee80211_sta_eosp when the NDP is sent.
6500 */
6501 void ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, int tid);
6502
6503 /**
6504 * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates - recalculate aggregate data after a change
6505 * @pubsta: the station
6506 *
6507 * Call this function after changing a per-link aggregate data as referenced in
6508 * &struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates by accessing the agg field of
6509 * &struct ieee80211_link_sta.
6510 *
6511 * With non MLO the data in deflink will be referenced directly. In that case
6512 * there is no need to call this function.
6513 */
6514 void ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6515
6516 /**
6517 * ieee80211_sta_register_airtime - register airtime usage for a sta/tid
6518 *
6519 * Register airtime usage for a given sta on a given tid. The driver must call
6520 * this function to notify mac80211 that a station used a certain amount of
6521 * airtime. This information will be used by the TXQ scheduler to schedule
6522 * stations in a way that ensures airtime fairness.
6523 *
6524 * The reported airtime should as a minimum include all time that is spent
6525 * transmitting to the remote station, including overhead and padding, but not
6526 * including time spent waiting for a TXOP. If the time is not reported by the
6527 * hardware it can in some cases be calculated from the rate and known frame
6528 * composition. When possible, the time should include any failed transmission
6529 * attempts.
6530 *
6531 * The driver can either call this function synchronously for every packet or
6532 * aggregate, or asynchronously as airtime usage information becomes available.
6533 * TX and RX airtime can be reported together, or separately by setting one of
6534 * them to 0.
6535 *
6536 * @pubsta: the station
6537 * @tid: the TID to register airtime for
6538 * @tx_airtime: airtime used during TX (in usec)
6539 * @rx_airtime: airtime used during RX (in usec)
6540 */
6541 void ieee80211_sta_register_airtime(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6542 u32 tx_airtime, u32 rx_airtime);
6543
6544 /**
6545 * ieee80211_txq_airtime_check - check if a txq can send frame to device
6546 *
6547 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6548 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6549 *
6550 * Return: %true if the AQL's airtime limit has not been reached and the txq can
6551 * continue to send more packets to the device. Otherwise return %false.
6552 */
6553 bool
6554 ieee80211_txq_airtime_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6555
6556 /**
6557 * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device
6558 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6559 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6560 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6561 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6562 *
6563 * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held; can sleep.
6564 *
6565 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6566 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6567 * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device
6568 * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend.
6569 *
6570 * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order
6571 * in which they were originally installed and handed to the
6572 * set_key callback.
6573 */
6574 void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6575 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6576 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6577 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6578 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6579 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6580 void *data),
6581 void *iter_data);
6582
6583 /**
6584 * ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu - iterate keys programmed into the device
6585 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6586 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6587 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6588 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6589 *
6590 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6591 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6592 * the device. Note that due to locking reasons, keys of station
6593 * in removal process will be skipped.
6594 *
6595 * This function requires being called in an RCU critical section,
6596 * and thus iter must be atomic.
6597 */
6598 void ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6599 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6600 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6601 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6602 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6603 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6604 void *data),
6605 void *iter_data);
6606
6607 /**
6608 * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic - iterate channel contexts
6609 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6610 * @iter: iterator function
6611 * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function
6612 *
6613 * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function is atomic and
6614 * doesn't acquire any locks internally that might be held in other
6615 * places while calling into the driver.
6616 *
6617 * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during
6618 * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being
6619 * removed.
6620 *
6621 * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed
6622 * before the restart are considered already present so will be
6623 * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already
6624 * or not.
6625 */
6626 void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic(
6627 struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6628 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6629 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf,
6630 void *data),
6631 void *iter_data);
6632
6633 /**
6634 * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
6635 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6636 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6637 *
6638 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
6639 * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate
6640 * information. This function must only be called from within the
6641 * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function
6642 * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return
6643 * %NULL.
6644 *
6645 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
6646 */
6647 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6648 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6649
6650 /**
6651 * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons
6652 *
6653 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6654 *
6655 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER and
6656 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the
6657 * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function.
6658 */
6659 void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6660
6661 /**
6662 * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP
6663 *
6664 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6665 *
6666 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER, and
6667 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver
6668 * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost.
6669 * The function may also be called if the connection needs to be terminated
6670 * for some other reason, even if %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR isn't set.
6671 *
6672 * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state,
6673 * without connection recovery attempts.
6674 */
6675 void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6676
6677 /**
6678 * ieee80211_disconnect - request disconnection
6679 *
6680 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6681 * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired
6682 *
6683 * Request disconnection from the current network and, if enabled, send a
6684 * hint to the higher layers that immediate reconnect is desired.
6685 */
6686 void ieee80211_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool reconnect);
6687
6688 /**
6689 * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume
6690 *
6691 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6692 *
6693 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume.
6694 * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the
6695 * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were
6696 * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or
6697 * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume.
6698 *
6699 * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses
6700 * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface
6701 * will still be added as associated first during resume and then
6702 * disconnect normally later.
6703 *
6704 * This function can only be called from the resume callback and
6705 * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it
6706 * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the
6707 * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto).
6708 */
6709 void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6710
6711 /**
6712 * ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect - disconnect from AP after
6713 * hardware restart
6714 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6715 *
6716 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after
6717 * hardware restart.
6718 */
6719 void ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6720
6721 /**
6722 * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring
6723 * rssi threshold triggered
6724 *
6725 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6726 * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type
6727 * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
6728 * @gfp: context flags
6729 *
6730 * When the %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality
6731 * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform
6732 * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold.
6733 */
6734 void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6735 enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
6736 s32 rssi_level,
6737 gfp_t gfp);
6738
6739 /**
6740 * ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - inform CQM of beacon loss
6741 *
6742 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6743 * @gfp: context flags
6744 */
6745 void ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, gfp_t gfp);
6746
6747 /**
6748 * ieee80211_radar_detected - inform that a radar was detected
6749 *
6750 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6751 * @chanctx_conf: Channel context on which radar is detected. Mandatory to
6752 * pass a valid pointer during MLO. For non-MLO %NULL can be passed
6753 */
6754 void ieee80211_radar_detected(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6755 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf);
6756
6757 /**
6758 * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process
6759 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6760 * @success: make the channel switch successful or not
6761 * @link_id: the link_id on which the switch was done. Ignored if success is
6762 * false.
6763 *
6764 * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel
6765 * and wake up the suspended queues.
6766 */
6767 void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success,
6768 unsigned int link_id);
6769
6770 /**
6771 * ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect - disconnect due to channel switch error
6772 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6773 * @block_tx: if %true, do not send deauth frame.
6774 *
6775 * Instruct mac80211 to disconnect due to a channel switch error. The channel
6776 * switch can request to block the tx and so, we need to make sure we do not send
6777 * a deauth frame in this case.
6778 */
6779 void ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6780 bool block_tx);
6781
6782 /**
6783 * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition
6784 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6785 * @link_id: link ID for MLO, or 0
6786 * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode
6787 *
6788 * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed
6789 * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than
6790 * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth.
6791 */
6792 void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
6793 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode);
6794
6795 /**
6796 * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start
6797 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6798 */
6799 void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6800
6801 /**
6802 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
6803 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6804 */
6805 void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6806
6807 /**
6808 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions
6809 *
6810 * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device
6811 * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba
6812 * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs
6813 * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)."
6814 * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and
6815 * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation.
6816 *
6817 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6818 * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid
6819 * @addr: & to bssid mac address
6820 */
6821 void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap,
6822 const u8 *addr);
6823
6824 /**
6825 * ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames - move RX BA window and mark filtered
6826 * @pubsta: station struct
6827 * @tid: the session's TID
6828 * @ssn: starting sequence number of the bitmap, all frames before this are
6829 * assumed to be out of the window after the call
6830 * @filtered: bitmap of filtered frames, BIT(0) is the @ssn entry etc.
6831 * @received_mpdus: number of received mpdus in firmware
6832 *
6833 * This function moves the BA window and releases all frames before @ssn, and
6834 * marks frames marked in the bitmap as having been filtered. Afterwards, it
6835 * checks if any frames in the window starting from @ssn can now be released
6836 * (in case they were only waiting for frames that were filtered.)
6837 * (Only work correctly if @max_rx_aggregation_subframes <= 64 frames)
6838 */
6839 void ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6840 u16 ssn, u64 filtered,
6841 u16 received_mpdus);
6842
6843 /**
6844 * ieee80211_send_bar - send a BlockAckReq frame
6845 *
6846 * can be used to flush pending frames from the peer's aggregation reorder
6847 * buffer.
6848 *
6849 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6850 * @ra: the peer's destination address
6851 * @tid: the TID of the aggregation session
6852 * @ssn: the new starting sequence number for the receiver
6853 */
6854 void ieee80211_send_bar(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 *ra, u16 tid, u16 ssn);
6855
6856 /**
6857 * ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl - helper to queue an RX BA work
6858 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6859 * @addr: station mac address
6860 * @tid: the rx tid
6861 */
6862 void ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *addr,
6863 unsigned int tid);
6864
6865 /**
6866 * ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl - start a Rx BA session
6867 *
6868 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6869 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6870 * reordering.
6871 *
6872 * Create structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6873 * when they complete AddBa negotiation.
6874 *
6875 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6876 * @addr: station mac address
6877 * @tid: the rx tid
6878 */
ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif * vif,const u8 * addr,u16 tid)6879 static inline void ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6880 const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6881 {
6882 if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6883 return;
6884 ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid);
6885 }
6886
6887 /**
6888 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl - stop a Rx BA session
6889 *
6890 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6891 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6892 * reordering.
6893 *
6894 * Destroy structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6895 * when they complete DelBa negotiation.
6896 *
6897 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6898 * @addr: station mac address
6899 * @tid: the rx tid
6900 */
ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif * vif,const u8 * addr,u16 tid)6901 static inline void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6902 const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6903 {
6904 if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6905 return;
6906 ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid + IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS);
6907 }
6908
6909 /**
6910 * ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired - stop a Rx BA session due to timeout
6911 *
6912 * Some device drivers do not offload AddBa/DelBa negotiation, but handle rx
6913 * buffer reording internally, and therefore also handle the session timer.
6914 *
6915 * Trigger the timeout flow, which sends a DelBa.
6916 *
6917 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6918 * @addr: station mac address
6919 * @tid: the rx tid
6920 */
6921 void ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6922 const u8 *addr, unsigned int tid);
6923
6924 /* Rate control API */
6925
6926 /**
6927 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo
6928 *
6929 * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for.
6930 * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on.
6931 * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration
6932 * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs
6933 * to be filled in
6934 * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate
6935 * which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and
6936 * used for rate calculations in the mesh network.
6937 * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the
6938 * RTS threshold
6939 * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission
6940 * if the selected rate supports it
6941 * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested (legacy) rate mask
6942 * @rate_idx_mcs_mask: user-requested MCS rate mask (NULL if not in use)
6943 * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode
6944 */
6945 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control {
6946 struct ieee80211_hw *hw;
6947 struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband;
6948 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf;
6949 struct sk_buff *skb;
6950 struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate;
6951 bool rts, short_preamble;
6952 u32 rate_idx_mask;
6953 u8 *rate_idx_mcs_mask;
6954 bool bss;
6955 };
6956
6957 /**
6958 * enum rate_control_capabilities - rate control capabilities
6959 */
6960 enum rate_control_capabilities {
6961 /**
6962 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW:
6963 * Support for extended NSS BW support (dot11VHTExtendedNSSCapable)
6964 * Note that this is only looked at if the minimum number of chains
6965 * that the AP uses is < the number of TX chains the hardware has,
6966 * otherwise the NSS difference doesn't bother us.
6967 */
6968 RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW = BIT(0),
6969 /**
6970 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER:
6971 * mac80211 should start A-MPDU sessions on tx
6972 */
6973 RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER = BIT(1),
6974 };
6975
6976 struct rate_control_ops {
6977 unsigned long capa;
6978 const char *name;
6979 void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6980 void (*add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, void *priv,
6981 struct dentry *debugfsdir);
6982 void (*free)(void *priv);
6983
6984 void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp);
6985 void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6986 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6987 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta);
6988 void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6989 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6990 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6991 u32 changed);
6992 void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6993 void *priv_sta);
6994
6995 void (*tx_status_ext)(void *priv,
6996 struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6997 void *priv_sta, struct ieee80211_tx_status *st);
6998 void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6999 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
7000 struct sk_buff *skb);
7001 void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
7002 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc);
7003
7004 void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta,
7005 struct dentry *dir);
7006
7007 u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(void *priv_sta);
7008 };
7009
rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta * sta,enum nl80211_band band,int index)7010 static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
7011 enum nl80211_band band,
7012 int index)
7013 {
7014 return (sta == NULL || sta->deflink.supp_rates[band] & BIT(index));
7015 }
7016
7017 static inline s8
rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_sta * sta)7018 rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7019 struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
7020 {
7021 int i;
7022
7023 for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
7024 if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
7025 return i;
7026
7027 /* warn when we cannot find a rate. */
7028 WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
7029
7030 /* and return 0 (the lowest index) */
7031 return 0;
7032 }
7033
7034 static inline
rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_sta * sta)7035 bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7036 struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
7037 {
7038 unsigned int i;
7039
7040 for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
7041 if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
7042 return true;
7043 return false;
7044 }
7045
7046 /**
7047 * rate_control_set_rates - pass the sta rate selection to mac80211/driver
7048 *
7049 * When not doing a rate control probe to test rates, rate control should pass
7050 * its rate selection to mac80211. If the driver supports receiving a station
7051 * rate table, it will use it to ensure that frames are always sent based on
7052 * the most recent rate control module decision.
7053 *
7054 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7055 * @pubsta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination.
7056 * @rates: new tx rate set to be used for this station.
7057 *
7058 * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
7059 */
7060 int rate_control_set_rates(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7061 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
7062 struct ieee80211_sta_rates *rates);
7063
7064 int ieee80211_rate_control_register(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
7065 void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
7066
7067 static inline bool
conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7068 conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7069 {
7070 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
7071 }
7072
7073 static inline bool
conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7074 conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7075 {
7076 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
7077 conf->chandef.center_freq1 < conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
7078 }
7079
7080 static inline bool
conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7081 conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7082 {
7083 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
7084 conf->chandef.center_freq1 > conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
7085 }
7086
7087 static inline bool
conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7088 conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7089 {
7090 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40;
7091 }
7092
7093 static inline bool
conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7094 conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7095 {
7096 return (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5) &&
7097 (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10) &&
7098 (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT);
7099 }
7100
7101 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type,bool p2p)7102 ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p)
7103 {
7104 if (p2p) {
7105 switch (type) {
7106 case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION:
7107 return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT;
7108 case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP:
7109 return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO;
7110 default:
7111 break;
7112 }
7113 }
7114 return type;
7115 }
7116
7117 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)7118 ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7119 {
7120 return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p);
7121 }
7122
7123 /**
7124 * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif - return HE capabilities for sband/vif
7125 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
7126 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7127 *
7128 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or %NULL is none found
7129 */
7130 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)7131 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7132 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7133 {
7134 return ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7135 }
7136
7137 /**
7138 * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif - return HE 6 GHz capabilities
7139 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
7140 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7141 *
7142 * Return: the 6GHz capabilities
7143 */
7144 static inline __le16
ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)7145 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7146 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7147 {
7148 return ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7149 }
7150
7151 /**
7152 * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif - return ETH capabilities for sband/vif
7153 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
7154 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7155 *
7156 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or %NULL is none found
7157 */
7158 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap *
ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)7159 ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7160 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7161 {
7162 return ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7163 }
7164
7165 /**
7166 * ieee80211_update_mu_groups - set the VHT MU-MIMO groud data
7167 *
7168 * @vif: the specified virtual interface
7169 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, otherwise 0
7170 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
7171 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
7172 *
7173 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid and the position and
7174 * membership data is of the correct size and are in the same byte order as the
7175 * matching GroupId management frame.
7176 * Calls to this function need to be serialized with RX path.
7177 */
7178 void ieee80211_update_mu_groups(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
7179 const u8 *membership, const u8 *position);
7180
7181 void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7182 int rssi_min_thold,
7183 int rssi_max_thold);
7184
7185 void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7186
7187 /**
7188 * ieee80211_ave_rssi - report the average RSSI for the specified interface
7189 *
7190 * @vif: the specified virtual interface
7191 *
7192 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid.
7193 *
7194 * Return: The average RSSI value for the requested interface, or 0 if not
7195 * applicable.
7196 */
7197 int ieee80211_ave_rssi(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7198
7199 /**
7200 * ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report WoWLAN wakeup
7201 * @vif: virtual interface
7202 * @wakeup: wakeup reason(s)
7203 * @gfp: allocation flags
7204 *
7205 * See cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup().
7206 */
7207 void ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7208 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
7209 gfp_t gfp);
7210
7211 /**
7212 * ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb - prepare an 802.11 skb for transmission
7213 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7214 * @vif: virtual interface
7215 * @skb: frame to be sent from within the driver
7216 * @band: the band to transmit on
7217 * @sta: optional pointer to get the station to send the frame to
7218 *
7219 * Return: %true if the skb was prepared, %false otherwise
7220 *
7221 * Note: must be called under RCU lock
7222 */
7223 bool ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7224 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct sk_buff *skb,
7225 int band, struct ieee80211_sta **sta);
7226
7227 /**
7228 * ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap - Sanity-check and parse the radiotap header
7229 * of injected frames.
7230 *
7231 * To accurately parse and take into account rate and retransmission fields,
7232 * you must initialize the chandef field in the ieee80211_tx_info structure
7233 * of the skb before calling this function.
7234 *
7235 * @skb: packet injected by userspace
7236 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
7237 *
7238 * Return: %true if the radiotap header was parsed, %false otherwise
7239 */
7240 bool ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap(struct sk_buff *skb,
7241 struct net_device *dev);
7242
7243 /**
7244 * struct ieee80211_noa_data - holds temporary data for tracking P2P NoA state
7245 *
7246 * @next_tsf: TSF timestamp of the next absent state change
7247 * @has_next_tsf: next absent state change event pending
7248 *
7249 * @absent: descriptor bitmask, set if GO is currently absent
7250 *
7251 * private:
7252 *
7253 * @count: count fields from the NoA descriptors
7254 * @desc: adjusted data from the NoA
7255 */
7256 struct ieee80211_noa_data {
7257 u32 next_tsf;
7258 bool has_next_tsf;
7259
7260 u8 absent;
7261
7262 u8 count[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
7263 struct {
7264 u32 start;
7265 u32 duration;
7266 u32 interval;
7267 } desc[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
7268 };
7269
7270 /**
7271 * ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa - initialize NoA tracking data from P2P IE
7272 *
7273 * @attr: P2P NoA IE
7274 * @data: NoA tracking data
7275 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
7276 *
7277 * Return: number of successfully parsed descriptors
7278 */
7279 int ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa(const struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr *attr,
7280 struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
7281
7282 /**
7283 * ieee80211_update_p2p_noa - get next pending P2P GO absent state change
7284 *
7285 * @data: NoA tracking data
7286 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
7287 */
7288 void ieee80211_update_p2p_noa(struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
7289
7290 /**
7291 * ieee80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform a TDLS operation
7292 * @vif: virtual interface
7293 * @peer: the peer's destination address
7294 * @oper: the requested TDLS operation
7295 * @reason_code: reason code for the operation, valid for TDLS teardown
7296 * @gfp: allocation flags
7297 *
7298 * See cfg80211_tdls_oper_request().
7299 */
7300 void ieee80211_tdls_oper_request(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *peer,
7301 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
7302 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
7303
7304 /**
7305 * ieee80211_reserve_tid - request to reserve a specific TID
7306 *
7307 * There is sometimes a need (such as in TDLS) for blocking the driver from
7308 * using a specific TID so that the FW can use it for certain operations such
7309 * as sending PTI requests. To make sure that the driver doesn't use that TID,
7310 * this function must be called as it flushes out packets on this TID and marks
7311 * it as blocked, so that any transmit for the station on this TID will be
7312 * redirected to the alternative TID in the same AC.
7313 *
7314 * Note that this function blocks and may call back into the driver, so it
7315 * should be called without driver locks held. Also note this function should
7316 * only be called from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7317 *
7318 * @sta: the station to reserve the TID for
7319 * @tid: the TID to reserve
7320 *
7321 * Returns: 0 on success, else on failure
7322 */
7323 int ieee80211_reserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7324
7325 /**
7326 * ieee80211_unreserve_tid - request to unreserve a specific TID
7327 *
7328 * Once there is no longer any need for reserving a certain TID, this function
7329 * should be called, and no longer will packets have their TID modified for
7330 * preventing use of this TID in the driver.
7331 *
7332 * Note that this function blocks and acquires a lock, so it should be called
7333 * without driver locks held. Also note this function should only be called
7334 * from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7335 *
7336 * @sta: the station
7337 * @tid: the TID to unreserve
7338 */
7339 void ieee80211_unreserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7340
7341 /**
7342 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7343 *
7344 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7345 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7346 * ieee80211_next_txq()
7347 *
7348 * Return: the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
7349 *
7350 * Note that this must be called in an rcu_read_lock() critical section,
7351 * which can only be released after the SKB was handled. Some pointers in
7352 * skb->cb, e.g. the key pointer, are protected by RCU and thus the
7353 * critical section must persist not just for the duration of this call
7354 * but for the duration of the frame handling.
7355 * However, also note that while in the wake_tx_queue() method,
7356 * rcu_read_lock() is already held.
7357 *
7358 * softirqs must also be disabled when this function is called.
7359 * In process context, use ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni() instead.
7360 */
7361 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7362 struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7363
7364 /**
7365 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7366 * (in process context)
7367 *
7368 * Like ieee80211_tx_dequeue() but can be called in process context
7369 * (internally disables bottom halves).
7370 *
7371 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7372 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7373 * ieee80211_next_txq()
7374 *
7375 * Return: the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
7376 */
ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq)7377 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7378 struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7379 {
7380 struct sk_buff *skb;
7381
7382 local_bh_disable();
7383 skb = ieee80211_tx_dequeue(hw, txq);
7384 local_bh_enable();
7385
7386 return skb;
7387 }
7388
7389 /**
7390 * ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue - mac80211 handler for wake_tx_queue callback
7391 *
7392 * @hw: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7393 * @txq: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7394 *
7395 * Drivers can use this function for the mandatory mac80211 wake_tx_queue
7396 * callback in struct ieee80211_ops. They should not call this function.
7397 */
7398 void ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7399 struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7400
7401 /**
7402 * ieee80211_next_txq - get next tx queue to pull packets from
7403 *
7404 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7405 * @ac: AC number to return packets from.
7406 *
7407 * Return: the next txq if successful, %NULL if no queue is eligible. If a txq
7408 * is returned, it should be returned with ieee80211_return_txq() after the
7409 * driver has finished scheduling it.
7410 */
7411 struct ieee80211_txq *ieee80211_next_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7412
7413 /**
7414 * ieee80211_txq_schedule_start - start new scheduling round for TXQs
7415 *
7416 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7417 * @ac: AC number to acquire locks for
7418 *
7419 * Should be called before ieee80211_next_txq() or ieee80211_return_txq().
7420 * The driver must not call multiple TXQ scheduling rounds concurrently.
7421 */
7422 void ieee80211_txq_schedule_start(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7423
7424 /* (deprecated) */
ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,u8 ac)7425 static inline void ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac)
7426 {
7427 }
7428
7429 void __ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7430 struct ieee80211_txq *txq, bool force);
7431
7432 /**
7433 * ieee80211_schedule_txq - schedule a TXQ for transmission
7434 *
7435 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7436 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7437 *
7438 * Schedules a TXQ for transmission if it is not already scheduled,
7439 * even if mac80211 does not have any packets buffered.
7440 *
7441 * The driver may call this function if it has buffered packets for
7442 * this TXQ internally.
7443 */
7444 static inline void
ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq)7445 ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7446 {
7447 __ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, true);
7448 }
7449
7450 /**
7451 * ieee80211_return_txq - return a TXQ previously acquired by ieee80211_next_txq()
7452 *
7453 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7454 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7455 * @force: schedule txq even if mac80211 does not have any buffered packets.
7456 *
7457 * The driver may set force=true if it has buffered packets for this TXQ
7458 * internally.
7459 */
7460 static inline void
ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq,bool force)7461 ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7462 bool force)
7463 {
7464 __ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, force);
7465 }
7466
7467 /**
7468 * ieee80211_txq_may_transmit - check whether TXQ is allowed to transmit
7469 *
7470 * This function is used to check whether given txq is allowed to transmit by
7471 * the airtime scheduler, and can be used by drivers to access the airtime
7472 * fairness accounting without using the scheduling order enforced by
7473 * next_txq().
7474 *
7475 * Returns %true if the airtime scheduler thinks the TXQ should be allowed to
7476 * transmit, and %false if it should be throttled. This function can also have
7477 * the side effect of rotating the TXQ in the scheduler rotation, which will
7478 * eventually bring the deficit to positive and allow the station to transmit
7479 * again.
7480 *
7481 * The API ieee80211_txq_may_transmit() also ensures that TXQ list will be
7482 * aligned against driver's own round-robin scheduler list. i.e it rotates
7483 * the TXQ list till it makes the requested node becomes the first entry
7484 * in TXQ list. Thus both the TXQ list and driver's list are in sync. If this
7485 * function returns %true, the driver is expected to schedule packets
7486 * for transmission, and then return the TXQ through ieee80211_return_txq().
7487 *
7488 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7489 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7490 *
7491 * Return: %true if transmission is allowed, %false otherwise
7492 */
7493 bool ieee80211_txq_may_transmit(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7494 struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7495
7496 /**
7497 * ieee80211_txq_get_depth - get pending frame/byte count of given txq
7498 *
7499 * The values are not guaranteed to be coherent with regard to each other, i.e.
7500 * txq state can change half-way of this function and the caller may end up
7501 * with "new" frame_cnt and "old" byte_cnt or vice-versa.
7502 *
7503 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7504 * @frame_cnt: pointer to store frame count
7505 * @byte_cnt: pointer to store byte count
7506 */
7507 void ieee80211_txq_get_depth(struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7508 unsigned long *frame_cnt,
7509 unsigned long *byte_cnt);
7510
7511 /**
7512 * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
7513 *
7514 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function termination.
7515 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7516 *
7517 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7518 * @inst_id: the local instance id
7519 * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
7520 * @gfp: allocation flags
7521 */
7522 void ieee80211_nan_func_terminated(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7523 u8 inst_id,
7524 enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
7525 gfp_t gfp);
7526
7527 /**
7528 * ieee80211_nan_func_match - notify about NAN function match event.
7529 *
7530 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function match. The
7531 * cookie inside the match struct will be assigned by mac80211.
7532 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7533 *
7534 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7535 * @match: match event information
7536 * @gfp: allocation flags
7537 */
7538 void ieee80211_nan_func_match(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7539 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match,
7540 gfp_t gfp);
7541
7542 /**
7543 * ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for RX.
7544 *
7545 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7546 * rate information in the RX status struct and the frame length.
7547 *
7548 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7549 * @status: &struct ieee80211_rx_status containing the transmission rate
7550 * information.
7551 * @len: frame length in bytes
7552 *
7553 * Return: the airtime estimate
7554 */
7555 u32 ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7556 struct ieee80211_rx_status *status,
7557 int len);
7558
7559 /**
7560 * ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for TX.
7561 *
7562 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7563 * rate information in the TX info struct and the frame length.
7564 *
7565 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7566 * @info: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
7567 * @len: frame length in bytes
7568 *
7569 * Return: the airtime estimate
7570 */
7571 u32 ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7572 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info,
7573 int len);
7574 /**
7575 * ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl - Get FILS discovery template.
7576 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7577 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7578 *
7579 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7580 *
7581 * Return: FILS discovery template. %NULL on error.
7582 */
7583 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7584 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7585
7586 /**
7587 * ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl - Get unsolicited broadcast
7588 * probe response template.
7589 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7590 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7591 *
7592 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7593 *
7594 * Return: Unsolicited broadcast probe response template. %NULL on error.
7595 */
7596 struct sk_buff *
7597 ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7598 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7599
7600 /**
7601 * ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify userland about a BSS color
7602 * collision.
7603 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
7604 *
7605 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7606 * @color_bitmap: a 64 bit bitmap representing the colors that the local BSS is
7607 * aware of.
7608 */
7609 void
7610 ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7611 u64 color_bitmap, u8 link_id);
7612
7613 /**
7614 * ieee80211_is_tx_data - check if frame is a data frame
7615 *
7616 * The function is used to check if a frame is a data frame. Frames with
7617 * hardware encapsulation enabled are data frames.
7618 *
7619 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
7620 *
7621 * Return: %true if @skb is a data frame, %false otherwise
7622 */
ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff * skb)7623 static inline bool ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff *skb)
7624 {
7625 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info = IEEE80211_SKB_CB(skb);
7626 struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (void *) skb->data;
7627
7628 return info->flags & IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP ||
7629 ieee80211_is_data(hdr->frame_control);
7630 }
7631
7632 /**
7633 * ieee80211_set_active_links - set active links in client mode
7634 * @vif: interface to set active links on
7635 * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7636 *
7637 * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held; may sleep; calls
7638 * back into the driver.
7639 *
7640 * This changes the active links on an interface. The interface
7641 * must be in client mode (in AP mode, all links are always active),
7642 * and @active_links must be a subset of the vif's valid_links.
7643 *
7644 * If a link is switched off and another is switched on at the same
7645 * time (e.g. active_links going from 0x1 to 0x10) then you will get
7646 * a sequence of calls like
7647 *
7648 * - change_vif_links(0x11)
7649 * - unassign_vif_chanctx(link_id=0)
7650 * - change_sta_links(0x11) for each affected STA (the AP)
7651 * (TDLS connections on now inactive links should be torn down)
7652 * - remove group keys on the old link (link_id 0)
7653 * - add new group keys (GTK/IGTK/BIGTK) on the new link (link_id 4)
7654 * - change_sta_links(0x10) for each affected STA (the AP)
7655 * - assign_vif_chanctx(link_id=4)
7656 * - change_vif_links(0x10)
7657 *
7658 * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
7659 */
7660 int ieee80211_set_active_links(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 active_links);
7661
7662 /**
7663 * ieee80211_set_active_links_async - asynchronously set active links
7664 * @vif: interface to set active links on
7665 * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7666 *
7667 * See ieee80211_set_active_links() for more information, the only
7668 * difference here is that the link change is triggered async and
7669 * can be called in any context, but the link switch will only be
7670 * completed after it returns.
7671 */
7672 void ieee80211_set_active_links_async(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7673 u16 active_links);
7674
7675 /**
7676 * ieee80211_send_teardown_neg_ttlm - tear down a negotiated TTLM request
7677 * @vif: the interface on which the tear down request should be sent.
7678 *
7679 * This function can be used to tear down a previously accepted negotiated
7680 * TTLM request.
7681 */
7682 void ieee80211_send_teardown_neg_ttlm(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7683
7684 /* for older drivers - let's not document these ... */
7685 int ieee80211_emulate_add_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7686 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
7687 void ieee80211_emulate_remove_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7688 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
7689 void ieee80211_emulate_change_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7690 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
7691 u32 changed);
7692 int ieee80211_emulate_switch_vif_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7693 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
7694 int n_vifs,
7695 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
7696
7697 #endif /* MAC80211_H */
7698